2003-12-26 Guilhem Lavaux <guilhem@kaffe.org>
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / config / mips / mips.c
blobba358fcfbf6ebcbc2f446205a0d077d2853804de
1 /* Subroutines used for MIPS code generation.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1990, 1991, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by A. Lichnewsky, lich@inria.inria.fr.
5 Changes by Michael Meissner, meissner@osf.org.
6 64 bit r4000 support by Ian Lance Taylor, ian@cygnus.com, and
7 Brendan Eich, brendan@microunity.com.
9 This file is part of GCC.
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
12 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
13 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
14 any later version.
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
17 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
18 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
19 GNU General Public License for more details.
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
23 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
24 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
26 #include "config.h"
27 #include "system.h"
28 #include "coretypes.h"
29 #include "tm.h"
30 #include <signal.h>
31 #include "rtl.h"
32 #include "regs.h"
33 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
34 #include "real.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "conditions.h"
37 #include "insn-attr.h"
38 #include "recog.h"
39 #include "toplev.h"
40 #include "output.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "function.h"
43 #include "expr.h"
44 #include "optabs.h"
45 #include "flags.h"
46 #include "reload.h"
47 #include "tm_p.h"
48 #include "ggc.h"
49 #include "gstab.h"
50 #include "hashtab.h"
51 #include "debug.h"
52 #include "target.h"
53 #include "target-def.h"
54 #include "integrate.h"
55 #include "langhooks.h"
57 /* Enumeration for all of the relational tests, so that we can build
58 arrays indexed by the test type, and not worry about the order
59 of EQ, NE, etc. */
61 enum internal_test {
62 ITEST_EQ,
63 ITEST_NE,
64 ITEST_GT,
65 ITEST_GE,
66 ITEST_LT,
67 ITEST_LE,
68 ITEST_GTU,
69 ITEST_GEU,
70 ITEST_LTU,
71 ITEST_LEU,
72 ITEST_MAX
75 /* Return true if it is likely that the given mode will be accessed
76 using only a single instruction. */
77 #define SINGLE_WORD_MODE_P(MODE) \
78 ((MODE) != BLKmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
80 /* True if the given SYMBOL_REF is for an internally-generated symbol. */
81 #define INTERNAL_SYMBOL_P(SYM) \
82 (XSTR (SYM, 0)[0] == '*' && XSTR (SYM, 0)[1] == LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX[0])
84 /* True if X is an unspec wrapper around a SYMBOL_REF or LABEL_REF. */
85 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P(X) \
86 (GET_CODE (X) == UNSPEC \
87 && XINT (X, 1) >= UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST \
88 && XINT (X, 1) < UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST + NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES)
90 /* Extract the symbol or label from UNSPEC wrapper X. */
91 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS(X) \
92 XVECEXP (X, 0, 0)
94 /* Extract the symbol type from UNSPEC wrapper X. */
95 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS_TYPE(X) \
96 ((enum mips_symbol_type) (XINT (X, 1) - UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST))
98 /* True if X is (const $gp). This is used to initialize the mips16
99 gp pseudo register. */
100 #define CONST_GP_P(X) \
101 (GET_CODE (X) == CONST && XEXP (X, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx)
103 /* The maximum distance between the top of the stack frame and the
104 value $sp has when we save & restore registers.
106 Use a maximum gap of 0x100 in the mips16 case. We can then use
107 unextended instructions to save and restore registers, and to
108 allocate and deallocate the top part of the frame.
110 The value in the !mips16 case must be a SMALL_OPERAND and must
111 preserve the maximum stack alignment. It could really be 0x7ff0,
112 but SGI's assemblers implement daddiu $sp,$sp,-0x7ff0 as a
113 multi-instruction addu sequence. Use 0x7fe0 to work around this. */
114 #define MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP (TARGET_MIPS16 ? 0x100 : 0x7fe0)
116 /* Classifies a SYMBOL_REF, LABEL_REF or UNSPEC address.
118 SYMBOL_GENERAL
119 Used when none of the below apply.
121 SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA
122 The symbol refers to something in a small data section.
124 SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL
125 The symbol refers to something in the mips16 constant pool.
127 SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL
128 The symbol refers to local data that will be found using
129 the global offset table.
131 SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL
132 Likewise non-local data.
134 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE
135 An UNSPEC wrapper around a SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL. It represents the
136 offset from _gp of a GOT page entry.
138 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL
139 An UNSPEC wrapper around a SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL. It represents the
140 the offset from _gp of the symbol's GOT entry.
142 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL
143 Like SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL, but used when calling a global function.
144 The GOT entry is allowed to point to a stub rather than to the
145 function itself.
147 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP
148 An UNSPEC wrapper around a function's address. It represents the
149 offset of _gp from the start of the function. */
150 enum mips_symbol_type {
151 SYMBOL_GENERAL,
152 SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA,
153 SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL,
154 SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL,
155 SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL,
156 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE,
157 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL,
158 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL,
159 SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP
161 #define NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES (SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP + 1)
164 /* Classifies an address.
166 ADDRESS_REG
167 A natural register + offset address. The register satisfies
168 mips_valid_base_register_p and the offset is a const_arith_operand.
170 ADDRESS_LO_SUM
171 A LO_SUM rtx. The first operand is a valid base register and
172 the second operand is a symbolic address.
174 ADDRESS_CONST_INT
175 A signed 16-bit constant address.
177 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
178 A constant symbolic address (equivalent to CONSTANT_SYMBOLIC). */
179 enum mips_address_type {
180 ADDRESS_REG,
181 ADDRESS_LO_SUM,
182 ADDRESS_CONST_INT,
183 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC
186 /* A function to save or store a register. The first argument is the
187 register and the second is the stack slot. */
188 typedef void (*mips_save_restore_fn) (rtx, rtx);
190 struct constant;
191 struct mips_arg_info;
192 struct mips_address_info;
193 struct mips_integer_op;
195 static enum mips_symbol_type mips_classify_symbol (rtx);
196 static void mips_split_const (rtx, rtx *, HOST_WIDE_INT *);
197 static bool mips_symbolic_constant_p (rtx, enum mips_symbol_type *);
198 static bool mips_valid_base_register_p (rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
199 static bool mips_symbolic_address_p (enum mips_symbol_type, enum machine_mode);
200 static bool mips_classify_address (struct mips_address_info *, rtx,
201 enum machine_mode, int);
202 static int mips_symbol_insns (enum mips_symbol_type);
203 static bool mips16_unextended_reference_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx, rtx);
204 static rtx mips_force_temporary (rtx, rtx);
205 static rtx mips_split_symbol (rtx, rtx);
206 static rtx mips_unspec_address (rtx, enum mips_symbol_type);
207 static rtx mips_unspec_offset_high (rtx, rtx, enum mips_symbol_type);
208 static rtx mips_load_got (rtx, rtx, enum mips_symbol_type);
209 static rtx mips_add_offset (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
210 static unsigned int mips_build_shift (struct mips_integer_op *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
211 static unsigned int mips_build_lower (struct mips_integer_op *,
212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
213 static unsigned int mips_build_integer (struct mips_integer_op *,
214 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
215 static void mips_move_integer (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
216 static void mips_legitimize_const_move (enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx);
217 static int m16_check_op (rtx, int, int, int);
218 static bool mips_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
219 static int mips_address_cost (rtx);
220 static enum internal_test map_test_to_internal_test (enum rtx_code);
221 static void get_float_compare_codes (enum rtx_code, enum rtx_code *,
222 enum rtx_code *);
223 static bool mips_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
224 static void mips_block_move_straight (rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
225 static void mips_adjust_block_mem (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx *, rtx *);
226 static void mips_block_move_loop (rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
227 static void mips_arg_info (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
228 tree, int, struct mips_arg_info *);
229 static bool mips_get_unaligned_mem (rtx *, unsigned int, int, rtx *, rtx *);
230 static void mips_set_architecture (const struct mips_cpu_info *);
231 static void mips_set_tune (const struct mips_cpu_info *);
232 static struct machine_function *mips_init_machine_status (void);
233 static void print_operand_reloc (FILE *, rtx, const char **);
234 static bool mips_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned int, int);
235 static void mips_file_start (void);
236 static void mips_file_end (void);
237 static bool mips_rewrite_small_data_p (rtx);
238 static int small_data_pattern_1 (rtx *, void *);
239 static int mips_rewrite_small_data_1 (rtx *, void *);
240 static bool mips_function_has_gp_insn (void);
241 static unsigned int mips_global_pointer (void);
242 static bool mips_save_reg_p (unsigned int);
243 static void mips_save_restore_reg (enum machine_mode, int, HOST_WIDE_INT,
244 mips_save_restore_fn);
245 static void mips_for_each_saved_reg (HOST_WIDE_INT, mips_save_restore_fn);
246 static void mips_output_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
247 static void mips_set_frame_expr (rtx);
248 static rtx mips_frame_set (rtx, rtx);
249 static void mips_save_reg (rtx, rtx);
250 static void mips_output_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
251 static void mips_restore_reg (rtx, rtx);
252 static int symbolic_expression_p (rtx);
253 static void mips_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode, rtx,
254 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
255 static void mips_select_section (tree, int, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
256 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
257 static bool mips_in_small_data_p (tree);
258 static void mips_encode_section_info (tree, rtx, int);
259 static int mips_fpr_return_fields (tree, tree *);
260 static bool mips_return_in_msb (tree);
261 static rtx mips_return_fpr_pair (enum machine_mode mode,
262 enum machine_mode mode1, HOST_WIDE_INT,
263 enum machine_mode mode2, HOST_WIDE_INT);
264 static rtx mips16_gp_pseudo_reg (void);
265 static void mips16_fp_args (FILE *, int, int);
266 static void build_mips16_function_stub (FILE *);
267 static void mips16_optimize_gp (void);
268 static rtx add_constant (struct constant **, rtx, enum machine_mode);
269 static void dump_constants (struct constant *, rtx);
270 static rtx mips_find_symbol (rtx);
271 static void mips16_lay_out_constants (void);
272 static void mips_avoid_hazard (rtx, rtx, int *, rtx *, rtx);
273 static void mips_avoid_hazards (void);
274 static void mips_reorg (void);
275 static bool mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *, const char *);
276 static bool mips_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *, const char *);
277 static const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_parse_cpu (const char *, const char *);
278 static const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_cpu_info_from_isa (int);
279 static int mips_adjust_cost (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
280 static int mips_issue_rate (void);
281 static int mips_use_dfa_pipeline_interface (void);
282 static void mips_init_libfuncs (void);
283 static tree mips_build_builtin_va_list (void);
285 #if TARGET_IRIX
286 static void irix_asm_named_section_1 (const char *, unsigned int,
287 unsigned int);
288 static void irix_asm_named_section (const char *, unsigned int);
289 static int irix_section_align_entry_eq (const void *, const void *);
290 static hashval_t irix_section_align_entry_hash (const void *);
291 static void irix_file_start (void);
292 static int irix_section_align_1 (void **, void *);
293 static void copy_file_data (FILE *, FILE *);
294 static void irix_file_end (void);
295 static unsigned int irix_section_type_flags (tree, const char *, int);
296 #endif
298 /* Structure to be filled in by compute_frame_size with register
299 save masks, and offsets for the current function. */
301 struct mips_frame_info GTY(())
303 HOST_WIDE_INT total_size; /* # bytes that the entire frame takes up */
304 HOST_WIDE_INT var_size; /* # bytes that variables take up */
305 HOST_WIDE_INT args_size; /* # bytes that outgoing arguments take up */
306 HOST_WIDE_INT cprestore_size; /* # bytes that the .cprestore slot takes up */
307 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store gp regs */
308 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store fp regs */
309 unsigned int mask; /* mask of saved gp registers */
310 unsigned int fmask; /* mask of saved fp registers */
311 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_save_offset; /* offset from vfp to store gp registers */
312 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_save_offset; /* offset from vfp to store fp registers */
313 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_sp_offset; /* offset from new sp to store gp registers */
314 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_sp_offset; /* offset from new sp to store fp registers */
315 bool initialized; /* true if frame size already calculated */
316 int num_gp; /* number of gp registers saved */
317 int num_fp; /* number of fp registers saved */
320 struct machine_function GTY(()) {
321 /* Pseudo-reg holding the address of the current function when
322 generating embedded PIC code. */
323 rtx embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx;
325 /* Pseudo-reg holding the value of $28 in a mips16 function which
326 refers to GP relative global variables. */
327 rtx mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx;
329 /* Current frame information, calculated by compute_frame_size. */
330 struct mips_frame_info frame;
332 /* Length of instructions in function; mips16 only. */
333 long insns_len;
335 /* The register to use as the global pointer within this function. */
336 unsigned int global_pointer;
338 /* True if mips_adjust_insn_length should ignore an instruction's
339 hazard attribute. */
340 bool ignore_hazard_length_p;
342 /* True if the whole function is suitable for .set noreorder and
343 .set nomacro. */
344 bool all_noreorder_p;
346 /* True if the function is known to have an instruction that needs $gp. */
347 bool has_gp_insn_p;
350 /* Information about a single argument. */
351 struct mips_arg_info
353 /* True if the argument is passed in a floating-point register, or
354 would have been if we hadn't run out of registers. */
355 bool fpr_p;
357 /* The argument's size, in bytes. */
358 unsigned int num_bytes;
360 /* The number of words passed in registers, rounded up. */
361 unsigned int reg_words;
363 /* The offset of the first register from GP_ARG_FIRST or FP_ARG_FIRST,
364 or MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS if the argument is passed entirely
365 on the stack. */
366 unsigned int reg_offset;
368 /* The number of words that must be passed on the stack, rounded up. */
369 unsigned int stack_words;
371 /* The offset from the start of the stack overflow area of the argument's
372 first stack word. Only meaningful when STACK_WORDS is nonzero. */
373 unsigned int stack_offset;
377 /* Information about an address described by mips_address_type.
379 ADDRESS_CONST_INT
380 No fields are used.
382 ADDRESS_REG
383 REG is the base register and OFFSET is the constant offset.
385 ADDRESS_LO_SUM
386 REG is the register that contains the high part of the address,
387 OFFSET is the symbolic address being referenced and SYMBOL_TYPE
388 is the type of OFFSET's symbol.
390 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC
391 SYMBOL_TYPE is the type of symbol being referenced. */
393 struct mips_address_info
395 enum mips_address_type type;
396 rtx reg;
397 rtx offset;
398 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
402 /* One stage in a constant building sequence. These sequences have
403 the form:
405 A = VALUE[0]
406 A = A CODE[1] VALUE[1]
407 A = A CODE[2] VALUE[2]
410 where A is an accumulator, each CODE[i] is a binary rtl operation
411 and each VALUE[i] is a constant integer. */
412 struct mips_integer_op {
413 enum rtx_code code;
414 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value;
418 /* The largest number of operations needed to load an integer constant.
419 The worst accepted case for 64-bit constants is LUI,ORI,SLL,ORI,SLL,ORI.
420 When the lowest bit is clear, we can try, but reject a sequence with
421 an extra SLL at the end. */
422 #define MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS 7
425 /* Global variables for machine-dependent things. */
427 /* Threshold for data being put into the small data/bss area, instead
428 of the normal data area. */
429 int mips_section_threshold = -1;
431 /* Count the number of .file directives, so that .loc is up to date. */
432 int num_source_filenames = 0;
434 /* Count the number of sdb related labels are generated (to find block
435 start and end boundaries). */
436 int sdb_label_count = 0;
438 /* Next label # for each statement for Silicon Graphics IRIS systems. */
439 int sym_lineno = 0;
441 /* Linked list of all externals that are to be emitted when optimizing
442 for the global pointer if they haven't been declared by the end of
443 the program with an appropriate .comm or initialization. */
445 struct extern_list GTY (())
447 struct extern_list *next; /* next external */
448 const char *name; /* name of the external */
449 int size; /* size in bytes */
452 static GTY (()) struct extern_list *extern_head = 0;
454 /* Name of the file containing the current function. */
455 const char *current_function_file = "";
457 /* Number of nested .set noreorder, noat, nomacro, and volatile requests. */
458 int set_noreorder;
459 int set_noat;
460 int set_nomacro;
461 int set_volatile;
463 /* The next branch instruction is a branch likely, not branch normal. */
464 int mips_branch_likely;
466 /* Cached operands, and operator to compare for use in set/branch/trap
467 on condition codes. */
468 rtx branch_cmp[2];
470 /* what type of branch to use */
471 enum cmp_type branch_type;
473 /* The target cpu for code generation. */
474 enum processor_type mips_arch;
475 const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_arch_info;
477 /* The target cpu for optimization and scheduling. */
478 enum processor_type mips_tune;
479 const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_tune_info;
481 /* Which instruction set architecture to use. */
482 int mips_isa;
484 /* Which ABI to use. */
485 int mips_abi;
487 /* Strings to hold which cpu and instruction set architecture to use. */
488 const char *mips_arch_string; /* for -march=<xxx> */
489 const char *mips_tune_string; /* for -mtune=<xxx> */
490 const char *mips_isa_string; /* for -mips{1,2,3,4} */
491 const char *mips_abi_string; /* for -mabi={32,n32,64,eabi} */
493 /* Whether we are generating mips16 hard float code. In mips16 mode
494 we always set TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT; this variable is nonzero if
495 -msoft-float was not specified by the user, which means that we
496 should arrange to call mips32 hard floating point code. */
497 int mips16_hard_float;
499 const char *mips_cache_flush_func = CACHE_FLUSH_FUNC;
501 /* If TRUE, we split addresses into their high and low parts in the RTL. */
502 int mips_split_addresses;
504 /* Mode used for saving/restoring general purpose registers. */
505 static enum machine_mode gpr_mode;
507 /* Array giving truth value on whether or not a given hard register
508 can support a given mode. */
509 char mips_hard_regno_mode_ok[(int)MAX_MACHINE_MODE][FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
511 /* The length of all strings seen when compiling for the mips16. This
512 is used to tell how many strings are in the constant pool, so that
513 we can see if we may have an overflow. This is reset each time the
514 constant pool is output. */
515 int mips_string_length;
517 /* When generating mips16 code, a list of all strings that are to be
518 output after the current function. */
520 static GTY(()) rtx mips16_strings;
522 /* In mips16 mode, we build a list of all the string constants we see
523 in a particular function. */
525 struct string_constant
527 struct string_constant *next;
528 const char *label;
531 static struct string_constant *string_constants;
533 /* List of all MIPS punctuation characters used by print_operand. */
534 char mips_print_operand_punct[256];
536 /* Map GCC register number to debugger register number. */
537 int mips_dbx_regno[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
539 /* An alias set for the GOT. */
540 static int mips_got_alias_set;
542 /* A copy of the original flag_delayed_branch: see override_options. */
543 static int mips_flag_delayed_branch;
545 static GTY (()) int mips_output_filename_first_time = 1;
547 /* mips_split_p[X] is true if symbols of type X can be split by
548 mips_split_symbol(). */
549 static bool mips_split_p[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
551 /* mips_lo_relocs[X] is the relocation to use when a symbol of type X
552 appears in a LO_SUM. It can be null if such LO_SUMs aren't valid or
553 if they are matched by a special .md file pattern. */
554 static const char *mips_lo_relocs[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
556 /* Likewise for HIGHs. */
557 static const char *mips_hi_relocs[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
559 /* Hardware names for the registers. If -mrnames is used, this
560 will be overwritten with mips_sw_reg_names. */
562 char mips_reg_names[][8] =
564 "$0", "$1", "$2", "$3", "$4", "$5", "$6", "$7",
565 "$8", "$9", "$10", "$11", "$12", "$13", "$14", "$15",
566 "$16", "$17", "$18", "$19", "$20", "$21", "$22", "$23",
567 "$24", "$25", "$26", "$27", "$28", "$sp", "$fp", "$31",
568 "$f0", "$f1", "$f2", "$f3", "$f4", "$f5", "$f6", "$f7",
569 "$f8", "$f9", "$f10", "$f11", "$f12", "$f13", "$f14", "$f15",
570 "$f16", "$f17", "$f18", "$f19", "$f20", "$f21", "$f22", "$f23",
571 "$f24", "$f25", "$f26", "$f27", "$f28", "$f29", "$f30", "$f31",
572 "hi", "lo", "", "$fcc0","$fcc1","$fcc2","$fcc3","$fcc4",
573 "$fcc5","$fcc6","$fcc7","", "", "", "", "$fakec",
574 "$c0r0", "$c0r1", "$c0r2", "$c0r3", "$c0r4", "$c0r5", "$c0r6", "$c0r7",
575 "$c0r8", "$c0r9", "$c0r10","$c0r11","$c0r12","$c0r13","$c0r14","$c0r15",
576 "$c0r16","$c0r17","$c0r18","$c0r19","$c0r20","$c0r21","$c0r22","$c0r23",
577 "$c0r24","$c0r25","$c0r26","$c0r27","$c0r28","$c0r29","$c0r30","$c0r31",
578 "$c2r0", "$c2r1", "$c2r2", "$c2r3", "$c2r4", "$c2r5", "$c2r6", "$c2r7",
579 "$c2r8", "$c2r9", "$c2r10","$c2r11","$c2r12","$c2r13","$c2r14","$c2r15",
580 "$c2r16","$c2r17","$c2r18","$c2r19","$c2r20","$c2r21","$c2r22","$c2r23",
581 "$c2r24","$c2r25","$c2r26","$c2r27","$c2r28","$c2r29","$c2r30","$c2r31",
582 "$c3r0", "$c3r1", "$c3r2", "$c3r3", "$c3r4", "$c3r5", "$c3r6", "$c3r7",
583 "$c3r8", "$c3r9", "$c3r10","$c3r11","$c3r12","$c3r13","$c3r14","$c3r15",
584 "$c3r16","$c3r17","$c3r18","$c3r19","$c3r20","$c3r21","$c3r22","$c3r23",
585 "$c3r24","$c3r25","$c3r26","$c3r27","$c3r28","$c3r29","$c3r30","$c3r31"
588 /* Mips software names for the registers, used to overwrite the
589 mips_reg_names array. */
591 char mips_sw_reg_names[][8] =
593 "$zero","$at", "$v0", "$v1", "$a0", "$a1", "$a2", "$a3",
594 "$t0", "$t1", "$t2", "$t3", "$t4", "$t5", "$t6", "$t7",
595 "$s0", "$s1", "$s2", "$s3", "$s4", "$s5", "$s6", "$s7",
596 "$t8", "$t9", "$k0", "$k1", "$gp", "$sp", "$fp", "$ra",
597 "$f0", "$f1", "$f2", "$f3", "$f4", "$f5", "$f6", "$f7",
598 "$f8", "$f9", "$f10", "$f11", "$f12", "$f13", "$f14", "$f15",
599 "$f16", "$f17", "$f18", "$f19", "$f20", "$f21", "$f22", "$f23",
600 "$f24", "$f25", "$f26", "$f27", "$f28", "$f29", "$f30", "$f31",
601 "hi", "lo", "", "$fcc0","$fcc1","$fcc2","$fcc3","$fcc4",
602 "$fcc5","$fcc6","$fcc7","$rap", "", "", "", "$fakec",
603 "$c0r0", "$c0r1", "$c0r2", "$c0r3", "$c0r4", "$c0r5", "$c0r6", "$c0r7",
604 "$c0r8", "$c0r9", "$c0r10","$c0r11","$c0r12","$c0r13","$c0r14","$c0r15",
605 "$c0r16","$c0r17","$c0r18","$c0r19","$c0r20","$c0r21","$c0r22","$c0r23",
606 "$c0r24","$c0r25","$c0r26","$c0r27","$c0r28","$c0r29","$c0r30","$c0r31",
607 "$c2r0", "$c2r1", "$c2r2", "$c2r3", "$c2r4", "$c2r5", "$c2r6", "$c2r7",
608 "$c2r8", "$c2r9", "$c2r10","$c2r11","$c2r12","$c2r13","$c2r14","$c2r15",
609 "$c2r16","$c2r17","$c2r18","$c2r19","$c2r20","$c2r21","$c2r22","$c2r23",
610 "$c2r24","$c2r25","$c2r26","$c2r27","$c2r28","$c2r29","$c2r30","$c2r31",
611 "$c3r0", "$c3r1", "$c3r2", "$c3r3", "$c3r4", "$c3r5", "$c3r6", "$c3r7",
612 "$c3r8", "$c3r9", "$c3r10","$c3r11","$c3r12","$c3r13","$c3r14","$c3r15",
613 "$c3r16","$c3r17","$c3r18","$c3r19","$c3r20","$c3r21","$c3r22","$c3r23",
614 "$c3r24","$c3r25","$c3r26","$c3r27","$c3r28","$c3r29","$c3r30","$c3r31"
617 /* Map hard register number to register class */
618 const enum reg_class mips_regno_to_class[] =
620 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS,
621 M16_REGS, M16_REGS, M16_REGS, M16_REGS,
622 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
623 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
624 M16_NA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
625 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
626 T_REG, PIC_FN_ADDR_REG, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
627 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
628 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
629 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
630 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
631 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
632 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
633 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
634 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
635 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
636 HI_REG, LO_REG, NO_REGS, ST_REGS,
637 ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS,
638 ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS, NO_REGS,
639 NO_REGS, NO_REGS, NO_REGS, NO_REGS,
640 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
641 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
642 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
643 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
644 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
645 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
646 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
647 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
648 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
649 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
650 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
651 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
652 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
653 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
654 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
655 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
656 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
657 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
658 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
659 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
660 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
661 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
662 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
663 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS
666 /* Map register constraint character to register class. */
667 enum reg_class mips_char_to_class[256];
669 /* A table describing all the processors gcc knows about. Names are
670 matched in the order listed. The first mention of an ISA level is
671 taken as the canonical name for that ISA.
673 To ease comparison, please keep this table in the same order as
674 gas's mips_cpu_info_table[]. */
675 const struct mips_cpu_info mips_cpu_info_table[] = {
676 /* Entries for generic ISAs */
677 { "mips1", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 },
678 { "mips2", PROCESSOR_R6000, 2 },
679 { "mips3", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 },
680 { "mips4", PROCESSOR_R8000, 4 },
681 { "mips32", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 },
682 { "mips32r2", PROCESSOR_M4K, 33 },
683 { "mips64", PROCESSOR_5KC, 64 },
685 /* MIPS I */
686 { "r3000", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 },
687 { "r2000", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 }, /* = r3000 */
688 { "r3900", PROCESSOR_R3900, 1 },
690 /* MIPS II */
691 { "r6000", PROCESSOR_R6000, 2 },
693 /* MIPS III */
694 { "r4000", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 },
695 { "vr4100", PROCESSOR_R4100, 3 },
696 { "vr4111", PROCESSOR_R4111, 3 },
697 { "vr4120", PROCESSOR_R4120, 3 },
698 { "vr4300", PROCESSOR_R4300, 3 },
699 { "r4400", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 }, /* = r4000 */
700 { "r4600", PROCESSOR_R4600, 3 },
701 { "orion", PROCESSOR_R4600, 3 }, /* = r4600 */
702 { "r4650", PROCESSOR_R4650, 3 },
704 /* MIPS IV */
705 { "r8000", PROCESSOR_R8000, 4 },
706 { "vr5000", PROCESSOR_R5000, 4 },
707 { "vr5400", PROCESSOR_R5400, 4 },
708 { "vr5500", PROCESSOR_R5500, 4 },
709 { "rm7000", PROCESSOR_R7000, 4 },
710 { "rm9000", PROCESSOR_R9000, 4 },
712 /* MIPS32 */
713 { "4kc", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 },
714 { "4kp", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 }, /* = 4kc */
716 /* MIPS32 Release 2 */
717 { "m4k", PROCESSOR_M4K, 33 },
719 /* MIPS64 */
720 { "5kc", PROCESSOR_5KC, 64 },
721 { "20kc", PROCESSOR_20KC, 64 },
722 { "sb1", PROCESSOR_SB1, 64 },
723 { "sr71000", PROCESSOR_SR71000, 64 },
725 /* End marker */
726 { 0, 0, 0 }
729 /* Nonzero if -march should decide the default value of MASK_SOFT_FLOAT. */
730 #ifndef MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT
731 #define MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT 0
732 #endif
734 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
735 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
736 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.half\t"
737 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
738 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.word\t"
739 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
740 #define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER mips_assemble_integer
742 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
743 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE mips_output_function_prologue
744 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
745 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE mips_output_function_epilogue
746 #undef TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
747 #define TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION mips_select_rtx_section
749 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
750 #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST mips_adjust_cost
751 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
752 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE mips_issue_rate
753 #undef TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
754 #define TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE mips_use_dfa_pipeline_interface
756 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
757 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL mips_function_ok_for_sibcall
759 #undef TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
760 #define TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE mips_valid_pointer_mode
761 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
762 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS mips_rtx_costs
763 #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
764 #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST mips_address_cost
766 #undef TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
767 #define TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO mips_encode_section_info
768 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
769 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P mips_in_small_data_p
771 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
772 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG mips_reorg
774 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
775 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
776 #if TARGET_IRIX
777 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START irix_file_start
778 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END irix_file_end
779 #else
780 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START mips_file_start
781 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END mips_file_end
782 #endif
783 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
784 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE true
786 #if TARGET_IRIX
787 #undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
788 #define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS irix_section_type_flags
789 #endif
791 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
792 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS mips_init_libfuncs
794 #undef TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
795 #define TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST mips_build_builtin_va_list
796 #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
797 #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB mips_return_in_msb
799 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
801 /* Classify symbol X, which must be a SYMBOL_REF or a LABEL_REF. */
803 static enum mips_symbol_type
804 mips_classify_symbol (rtx x)
806 if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
807 return (TARGET_ABICALLS ? SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL : SYMBOL_GENERAL);
809 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
810 abort ();
812 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x))
814 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
815 return SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL;
817 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
818 return SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL;
820 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (x)) <= mips_section_threshold)
821 return SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA;
823 return SYMBOL_GENERAL;
826 if (INTERNAL_SYMBOL_P (x))
828 /* The symbol is a local label. For TARGET_MIPS16, SYMBOL_REF_FLAG
829 will be set if the symbol refers to a string in the current
830 function's constant pool. */
831 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (x))
832 return SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL;
834 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
835 return SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL;
838 if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (x))
839 return SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA;
841 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
842 return (SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (x) ? SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL : SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL);
844 return SYMBOL_GENERAL;
848 /* Split X into a base and a constant offset, storing them in *BASE
849 and *OFFSET respectively. */
851 static void
852 mips_split_const (rtx x, rtx *base, HOST_WIDE_INT *offset)
854 *offset = 0;
856 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
857 x = XEXP (x, 0);
859 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
861 *offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
862 x = XEXP (x, 0);
864 *base = x;
868 /* Return true if X is a symbolic constant that can be calculated in
869 the same way as a bare symbol. If it is, store the type of the
870 symbol in *SYMBOL_TYPE. */
872 static bool
873 mips_symbolic_constant_p (rtx x, enum mips_symbol_type *symbol_type)
875 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
877 mips_split_const (x, &x, &offset);
878 if (UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P (x))
879 *symbol_type = UNSPEC_ADDRESS_TYPE (x);
880 else if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
881 *symbol_type = mips_classify_symbol (x);
882 else
883 return false;
885 if (offset == 0)
886 return true;
888 /* Check whether a nonzero offset is valid for the underlying
889 relocations. */
890 switch (*symbol_type)
892 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
893 /* %hi() and %lo() can handle anything. */
894 return true;
896 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
897 /* Make sure that the offset refers to something within the
898 -G limit. If the offset is allowed to grow too much,
899 it could overflow the range of %gp_rel(). */
900 return (offset > 0 && offset < mips_section_threshold);
902 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
903 /* Similarly check the range of offsets for mips16 constant
904 pool entries. */
905 return (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x)
906 && offset > 0
907 && offset < (int) GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (x)));
909 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
910 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
911 /* The linker should provide enough local GOT entries for a
912 16-bit offset. Larger offsets may lead to GOT overflow. */
913 return SMALL_OPERAND (offset);
915 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
916 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
917 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
918 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
919 return false;
921 abort ();
925 /* This function is used to implement REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P. */
928 mips_reg_mode_ok_for_base_p (rtx reg, enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
930 return (strict
931 ? REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (REGNO (reg), mode)
932 : GP_REG_OR_PSEUDO_NONSTRICT_P (REGNO (reg), mode));
936 /* Return true if X is a valid base register for the given mode.
937 Allow only hard registers if STRICT. */
939 static bool
940 mips_valid_base_register_p (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
942 if (!strict && GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
943 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
945 return (GET_CODE (x) == REG
946 && mips_reg_mode_ok_for_base_p (x, mode, strict));
950 /* Return true if symbols of type SYMBOL_TYPE can directly address a value
951 with mode MODE. This is used for both symbolic and LO_SUM addresses. */
953 static bool
954 mips_symbolic_address_p (enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type,
955 enum machine_mode mode)
957 switch (symbol_type)
959 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
960 return !TARGET_MIPS16;
962 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
963 return true;
965 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
966 /* PC-relative addressing is only available for lw, sw, ld and sd. */
967 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8;
969 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
970 return true;
972 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
973 /* The address will have to be loaded from the GOT first. */
974 return false;
976 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
977 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
978 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
979 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
980 return true;
982 abort ();
986 /* Return true if X is a valid address for machine mode MODE. If it is,
987 fill in INFO appropriately. STRICT is true if we should only accept
988 hard base registers. */
990 static bool
991 mips_classify_address (struct mips_address_info *info, rtx x,
992 enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
994 switch (GET_CODE (x))
996 case REG:
997 case SUBREG:
998 info->type = ADDRESS_REG;
999 info->reg = x;
1000 info->offset = const0_rtx;
1001 return mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict);
1003 case PLUS:
1004 info->type = ADDRESS_REG;
1005 info->reg = XEXP (x, 0);
1006 info->offset = XEXP (x, 1);
1007 return (mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict)
1008 && const_arith_operand (info->offset, VOIDmode));
1010 case LO_SUM:
1011 info->type = ADDRESS_LO_SUM;
1012 info->reg = XEXP (x, 0);
1013 info->offset = XEXP (x, 1);
1014 return (mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict)
1015 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (info->offset, &info->symbol_type)
1016 && mips_symbolic_address_p (info->symbol_type, mode)
1017 && mips_lo_relocs[info->symbol_type] != 0);
1019 case CONST_INT:
1020 /* Small-integer addresses don't occur very often, but they
1021 are legitimate if $0 is a valid base register. */
1022 info->type = ADDRESS_CONST_INT;
1023 return !TARGET_MIPS16 && SMALL_INT (x);
1025 case CONST:
1026 case LABEL_REF:
1027 case SYMBOL_REF:
1028 info->type = ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC;
1029 return (mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &info->symbol_type)
1030 && mips_symbolic_address_p (info->symbol_type, mode)
1031 && !mips_split_p[info->symbol_type]);
1033 default:
1034 return false;
1038 /* Return the number of instructions needed to load a symbol of the
1039 given type into a register. If valid in an address, the same number
1040 of instructions are needed for loads and stores. Treat extended
1041 mips16 instructions as two instructions. */
1043 static int
1044 mips_symbol_insns (enum mips_symbol_type type)
1046 switch (type)
1048 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
1049 /* In mips16 code, general symbols must be fetched from the
1050 constant pool. */
1051 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1052 return 0;
1054 /* When using 64-bit symbols, we need 5 preparatory instructions,
1055 such as:
1057 lui $at,%highest(symbol)
1058 daddiu $at,$at,%higher(symbol)
1059 dsll $at,$at,16
1060 daddiu $at,$at,%hi(symbol)
1061 dsll $at,$at,16
1063 The final address is then $at + %lo(symbol). With 32-bit
1064 symbols we just need a preparatory lui. */
1065 return (ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS ? 6 : 2);
1067 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
1068 return 1;
1070 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
1071 /* This case is for mips16 only. Assume we'll need an
1072 extended instruction. */
1073 return 2;
1075 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
1076 /* For o32 and o64, the sequence is:
1078 lw $at,%got(symbol)
1081 and the final address is $at + %lo(symbol). A load/add
1082 sequence is also needed for n32 and n64. Some versions
1083 of GAS insert a nop in the n32/n64 sequences too so, for
1084 simplicity, use the worst case of 3 instructions. */
1085 return 3;
1087 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
1088 /* When using a small GOT, we just fetch the address using
1089 a gp-relative load. For a big GOT, we need a sequence
1090 such as:
1092 lui $at,%got_hi(symbol)
1093 daddu $at,$at,$gp
1095 and the final address is $at + %got_lo(symbol). */
1096 return (TARGET_XGOT ? 3 : 1);
1098 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
1099 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
1100 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
1101 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
1102 /* Check whether the offset is a 16- or 32-bit value. */
1103 return mips_split_p[type] ? 2 : 1;
1105 abort ();
1109 /* Return true if a value at OFFSET bytes from BASE can be accessed
1110 using an unextended mips16 instruction. MODE is the mode of the
1111 value.
1113 Usually the offset in an unextended instruction is a 5-bit field.
1114 The offset is unsigned and shifted left once for HIs, twice
1115 for SIs, and so on. An exception is SImode accesses off the
1116 stack pointer, which have an 8-bit immediate field. */
1118 static bool
1119 mips16_unextended_reference_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, rtx offset)
1121 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1122 && GET_CODE (offset) == CONST_INT
1123 && INTVAL (offset) >= 0
1124 && (INTVAL (offset) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) == 0)
1126 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 && base == stack_pointer_rtx)
1127 return INTVAL (offset) < 256 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1128 return INTVAL (offset) < 32 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1130 return false;
1134 /* Return the number of instructions needed to load or store a value
1135 of mode MODE at X. Return 0 if X isn't valid for MODE.
1137 For mips16 code, count extended instructions as two instructions. */
1140 mips_address_insns (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode)
1142 struct mips_address_info addr;
1143 int factor;
1145 /* Each word of a multi-word value will be accessed individually. */
1146 factor = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
1147 if (mips_classify_address (&addr, x, mode, false))
1148 switch (addr.type)
1150 case ADDRESS_REG:
1151 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1152 && !mips16_unextended_reference_p (mode, addr.reg, addr.offset))
1153 return factor * 2;
1154 return factor;
1156 case ADDRESS_LO_SUM:
1157 return (TARGET_MIPS16 ? factor * 2 : factor);
1159 case ADDRESS_CONST_INT:
1160 return factor;
1162 case ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
1163 return factor * mips_symbol_insns (addr.symbol_type);
1165 return 0;
1169 /* Likewise for constant X. */
1172 mips_const_insns (rtx x)
1174 struct mips_integer_op codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1175 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1176 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1178 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1180 case CONSTANT_P_RTX:
1181 return 1;
1183 case HIGH:
1184 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1185 || !mips_symbolic_constant_p (XEXP (x, 0), &symbol_type)
1186 || !mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1187 return 0;
1189 return 1;
1191 case CONST_INT:
1192 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1193 /* Unsigned 8-bit constants can be loaded using an unextended
1194 LI instruction. Unsigned 16-bit constants can be loaded
1195 using an extended LI. Negative constants must be loaded
1196 using LI and then negated. */
1197 return (INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 256 ? 1
1198 : SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (INTVAL (x)) ? 2
1199 : INTVAL (x) > -256 && INTVAL (x) < 0 ? 2
1200 : SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (-INTVAL (x)) ? 3
1201 : 0);
1203 return mips_build_integer (codes, INTVAL (x));
1205 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1206 return (!TARGET_MIPS16 && x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)) ? 1 : 0);
1208 case CONST:
1209 if (CONST_GP_P (x))
1210 return 1;
1212 /* See if we can refer to X directly. */
1213 if (mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &symbol_type))
1214 return mips_symbol_insns (symbol_type);
1216 /* Otherwise try splitting the constant into a base and offset.
1217 16-bit offsets can be added using an extra addiu. Larger offsets
1218 must be calculated separately and then added to the base. */
1219 mips_split_const (x, &x, &offset);
1220 if (offset != 0)
1222 int n = mips_const_insns (x);
1223 if (n != 0)
1225 if (SMALL_OPERAND (offset))
1226 return n + 1;
1227 else
1228 return n + 1 + mips_build_integer (codes, offset);
1231 return 0;
1233 case SYMBOL_REF:
1234 case LABEL_REF:
1235 return mips_symbol_insns (mips_classify_symbol (x));
1237 default:
1238 return 0;
1243 /* Return the number of instructions needed for memory reference X.
1244 Count extended mips16 instructions as two instructions. */
1247 mips_fetch_insns (rtx x)
1249 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
1250 abort ();
1252 return mips_address_insns (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
1256 /* Return truth value of whether OP can be used as an operands
1257 where a register or 16 bit unsigned integer is needed. */
1260 uns_arith_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1262 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT && SMALL_INT_UNSIGNED (op))
1263 return 1;
1265 return register_operand (op, mode);
1269 /* True if OP can be treated as a signed 16-bit constant. */
1272 const_arith_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1274 return GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT && SMALL_INT (op);
1278 /* Return true if OP is a register operand or a signed 16-bit constant. */
1281 arith_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1283 return const_arith_operand (op, mode) || register_operand (op, mode);
1286 /* Return truth value of whether OP is an integer which fits in 16 bits. */
1289 small_int (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1291 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT && SMALL_INT (op));
1294 /* Return truth value of whether OP is a register or the constant 0.
1295 Do not accept 0 in mips16 mode since $0 is not one of the core 8
1296 registers. */
1299 reg_or_0_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1301 switch (GET_CODE (op))
1303 case CONST_INT:
1304 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1305 return 0;
1306 return INTVAL (op) == 0;
1308 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1309 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1310 return 0;
1311 return op == CONST0_RTX (mode);
1313 default:
1314 return register_operand (op, mode);
1318 /* Accept a register or the floating point constant 1 in the appropriate mode. */
1321 reg_or_const_float_1_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1323 REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
1325 switch (GET_CODE (op))
1327 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1328 if (mode != GET_MODE (op)
1329 || (mode != DFmode && mode != SFmode))
1330 return 0;
1332 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op);
1333 return REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d, dconst1);
1335 default:
1336 return register_operand (op, mode);
1340 /* Accept the floating point constant 1 in the appropriate mode. */
1343 const_float_1_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1345 REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
1347 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST_DOUBLE
1348 || mode != GET_MODE (op)
1349 || (mode != DFmode && mode != SFmode))
1350 return 0;
1352 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, op);
1354 return REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (d, dconst1);
1357 /* Return true if OP is either the HI or LO register. */
1360 hilo_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1362 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
1363 && REG_P (op) && MD_REG_P (REGNO (op)));
1366 /* Return true if OP is an extension operator. */
1369 extend_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1371 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
1372 && (GET_CODE (op) == ZERO_EXTEND || GET_CODE (op) == SIGN_EXTEND));
1375 /* Return nonzero if the code of this rtx pattern is EQ or NE. */
1378 equality_op (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1380 if (mode != GET_MODE (op))
1381 return 0;
1383 return GET_CODE (op) == EQ || GET_CODE (op) == NE;
1386 /* Return nonzero if the code is a relational operations (EQ, LE, etc.) */
1389 cmp_op (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1391 if (mode != GET_MODE (op))
1392 return 0;
1394 return GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (op)) == '<';
1397 /* Return nonzero if the code is a relational operation suitable for a
1398 conditional trap instruction (only EQ, NE, LT, LTU, GE, GEU).
1399 We need this in the insn that expands `trap_if' in order to prevent
1400 combine from erroneously altering the condition. */
1403 trap_cmp_op (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1405 if (mode != GET_MODE (op))
1406 return 0;
1408 switch (GET_CODE (op))
1410 case EQ:
1411 case NE:
1412 case LT:
1413 case LTU:
1414 case GE:
1415 case GEU:
1416 return 1;
1418 default:
1419 return 0;
1423 /* Return nonzero if the operand is either the PC or a label_ref. */
1426 pc_or_label_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1428 if (op == pc_rtx)
1429 return 1;
1431 if (GET_CODE (op) == LABEL_REF)
1432 return 1;
1434 return 0;
1437 /* Test for a valid call address. */
1440 call_insn_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1442 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1444 if (mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type))
1445 switch (symbol_type)
1447 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
1448 /* If -mlong-calls, force all calls to use register addressing. */
1449 return !TARGET_LONG_CALLS;
1451 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
1452 /* Without explicit relocs, there is no special syntax for
1453 loading the address of a call destination into a register.
1454 Using "la $25,foo; jal $25" would prevent the lazy binding
1455 of "foo", so keep the address of global symbols with the
1456 jal macro. */
1457 return !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS;
1459 default:
1460 return false;
1462 return register_operand (op, mode);
1466 /* Return nonzero if OP is valid as a source operand for a move
1467 instruction. */
1470 move_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1472 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1474 if (!general_operand (op, mode))
1475 return false;
1477 switch (GET_CODE (op))
1479 case CONST_INT:
1480 /* When generating mips16 code, LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P rejects
1481 CONST_INTs that can't be loaded using simple insns. */
1482 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1483 return true;
1485 /* Otherwise check whether the constant can be loaded in a single
1486 instruction. */
1487 return LUI_INT (op) || SMALL_INT (op) || SMALL_INT_UNSIGNED (op);
1489 case CONST:
1490 case SYMBOL_REF:
1491 case LABEL_REF:
1492 if (CONST_GP_P (op))
1493 return true;
1495 return (mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type)
1496 && !mips_split_p[symbol_type]);
1498 default:
1499 return true;
1504 /* Accept any operand that can appear in a mips16 constant table
1505 instruction. We can't use any of the standard operand functions
1506 because for these instructions we accept values that are not
1507 accepted by LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT, such as arbitrary SYMBOL_REFs. */
1510 consttable_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1512 return CONSTANT_P (op);
1515 /* Return 1 if OP is a symbolic operand, i.e. a symbol_ref or a label_ref,
1516 possibly with an offset. */
1519 symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1521 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1523 return mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type);
1527 /* Return true if we're generating PIC and OP is a global symbol. */
1530 global_got_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1532 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1534 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
1535 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type)
1536 && symbol_type == SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL);
1540 /* Likewise for local symbols. */
1543 local_got_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1545 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1547 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
1548 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type)
1549 && symbol_type == SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL);
1553 /* Return true if OP is a memory reference that uses the stack pointer
1554 as a base register. */
1557 stack_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1559 struct mips_address_info addr;
1561 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
1562 && GET_CODE (op) == MEM
1563 && mips_classify_address (&addr, XEXP (op, 0), GET_MODE (op), false)
1564 && addr.type == ADDRESS_REG
1565 && addr.reg == stack_pointer_rtx);
1569 /* This function is used to implement GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS. It
1570 returns a nonzero value if X is a legitimate address for a memory
1571 operand of the indicated MODE. STRICT is nonzero if this function
1572 is called during reload. */
1574 bool
1575 mips_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int strict)
1577 struct mips_address_info addr;
1579 return mips_classify_address (&addr, x, mode, strict);
1583 /* Copy VALUE to a register and return that register. If new psuedos
1584 are allowed, copy it into a new register, otherwise use DEST. */
1586 static rtx
1587 mips_force_temporary (rtx dest, rtx value)
1589 if (!no_new_pseudos)
1590 return force_reg (Pmode, value);
1591 else
1593 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (dest), value);
1594 return dest;
1599 /* Return a LO_SUM expression for ADDR. TEMP is as for mips_force_temporary
1600 and is used to load the high part into a register. */
1602 static rtx
1603 mips_split_symbol (rtx temp, rtx addr)
1605 rtx high;
1607 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1608 high = mips16_gp_pseudo_reg ();
1609 else
1610 high = mips_force_temporary (temp, gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, copy_rtx (addr)));
1611 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, high, addr);
1615 /* Return an UNSPEC address with underlying address ADDRESS and symbol
1616 type SYMBOL_TYPE. */
1618 static rtx
1619 mips_unspec_address (rtx address, enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type)
1621 rtx base;
1622 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1624 mips_split_const (address, &base, &offset);
1625 base = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, base),
1626 UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST + symbol_type);
1627 return plus_constant (gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, base), offset);
1631 /* If mips_unspec_address (ADDR, SYMBOL_TYPE) is a 32-bit value, add the
1632 high part to BASE and return the result. Just return BASE otherwise.
1634 The returned expression can be used as the first operand to a LO_SUM. */
1636 static rtx
1637 mips_unspec_offset_high (rtx base, rtx addr, enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type)
1639 if (mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1641 addr = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, mips_unspec_address (addr, symbol_type));
1642 base = force_reg (Pmode, expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, base, addr,
1643 NULL, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN));
1645 return base;
1649 /* Return a memory reference for the GOT slot whose offset is given by
1650 mips_unspec_address (ADDR, SYMBOL_TYPE). Register BASE contains the
1651 high part of the offset plus $gp. */
1653 static rtx
1654 mips_load_got (rtx base, rtx addr, enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type)
1656 rtx mem, offset;
1658 offset = mips_unspec_address (addr, symbol_type);
1659 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (ptr_mode, gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, base, offset));
1660 set_mem_alias_set (mem, mips_got_alias_set);
1662 /* GOT entries are constant and references to them can't trap. */
1663 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (mem) = 1;
1664 MEM_NOTRAP_P (mem) = 1;
1666 return mem;
1670 /* Return the offset of ADDR's GOT entry from _gp. ADDR is a
1671 global_got_operand. */
1674 mips_gotoff_global (rtx addr)
1676 return mips_unspec_address (addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL);
1680 /* Fetch the high part of local_got_operand ADDR from the GOT. */
1683 mips_load_got_page (rtx addr)
1685 return mips_load_got (pic_offset_table_rtx, addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE);
1689 /* Fetch the address of global_got_operand ADDR from the GOT. BASE is a
1690 register that holds the address _gp + %got_hi(ADDR). */
1693 mips_load_got_global (rtx base, rtx addr)
1695 return mips_load_got (base, addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL);
1699 /* Return a legitimate address for REG + OFFSET. This function will
1700 create a temporary register if OFFSET is not a SMALL_OPERAND. */
1702 static rtx
1703 mips_add_offset (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1705 if (!SMALL_OPERAND (offset))
1706 reg = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (reg), PLUS,
1707 GEN_INT (CONST_HIGH_PART (offset)),
1708 reg, NULL, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1710 return plus_constant (reg, CONST_LOW_PART (offset));
1714 /* This function is used to implement LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS. If *XLOC can
1715 be legitimized in a way that the generic machinery might not expect,
1716 put the new address in *XLOC and return true. MODE is the mode of
1717 the memory being accessed. */
1719 bool
1720 mips_legitimize_address (rtx *xloc, enum machine_mode mode)
1722 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1724 /* See if the address can split into a high part and a LO_SUM. */
1725 if (mips_symbolic_constant_p (*xloc, &symbol_type)
1726 && mips_symbolic_address_p (symbol_type, mode)
1727 && mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1729 *xloc = mips_split_symbol (0, *xloc);
1730 return true;
1733 if (GET_CODE (*xloc) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (*xloc, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1735 /* Handle REG + CONSTANT using mips_add_offset. */
1736 rtx reg;
1738 reg = XEXP (*xloc, 0);
1739 if (!mips_valid_base_register_p (reg, mode, 0))
1740 reg = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, reg);
1741 *xloc = mips_add_offset (reg, INTVAL (XEXP (*xloc, 1)));
1742 return true;
1745 return false;
1749 /* Subroutine of mips_build_integer (with the same interface).
1750 Assume that the final action in the sequence should be a left shift. */
1752 static unsigned int
1753 mips_build_shift (struct mips_integer_op *codes, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1755 unsigned int i, shift;
1757 /* Shift VALUE right until its lowest bit is set. Shift arithmetically
1758 since signed numbers are easier to load than unsigned ones. */
1759 shift = 0;
1760 while ((value & 1) == 0)
1761 value /= 2, shift++;
1763 i = mips_build_integer (codes, value);
1764 codes[i].code = ASHIFT;
1765 codes[i].value = shift;
1766 return i + 1;
1770 /* As for mips_build_shift, but assume that the final action will be
1771 an IOR or PLUS operation. */
1773 static unsigned int
1774 mips_build_lower (struct mips_integer_op *codes, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1776 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT high;
1777 unsigned int i;
1779 high = value & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffff;
1780 if (!LUI_OPERAND (high) && (value & 0x18000) == 0x18000)
1782 /* The constant is too complex to load with a simple lui/ori pair
1783 so our goal is to clear as many trailing zeros as possible.
1784 In this case, we know bit 16 is set and that the low 16 bits
1785 form a negative number. If we subtract that number from VALUE,
1786 we will clear at least the lowest 17 bits, maybe more. */
1787 i = mips_build_integer (codes, CONST_HIGH_PART (value));
1788 codes[i].code = PLUS;
1789 codes[i].value = CONST_LOW_PART (value);
1791 else
1793 i = mips_build_integer (codes, high);
1794 codes[i].code = IOR;
1795 codes[i].value = value & 0xffff;
1797 return i + 1;
1801 /* Fill CODES with a sequence of rtl operations to load VALUE.
1802 Return the number of operations needed. */
1804 static unsigned int
1805 mips_build_integer (struct mips_integer_op *codes,
1806 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1808 if (SMALL_OPERAND (value)
1809 || SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (value)
1810 || LUI_OPERAND (value))
1812 /* The value can be loaded with a single instruction. */
1813 codes[0].code = NIL;
1814 codes[0].value = value;
1815 return 1;
1817 else if ((value & 1) != 0 || LUI_OPERAND (CONST_HIGH_PART (value)))
1819 /* Either the constant is a simple LUI/ORI combination or its
1820 lowest bit is set. We don't want to shift in this case. */
1821 return mips_build_lower (codes, value);
1823 else if ((value & 0xffff) == 0)
1825 /* The constant will need at least three actions. The lowest
1826 16 bits are clear, so the final action will be a shift. */
1827 return mips_build_shift (codes, value);
1829 else
1831 /* The final action could be a shift, add or inclusive OR.
1832 Rather than use a complex condition to select the best
1833 approach, try both mips_build_shift and mips_build_lower
1834 and pick the one that gives the shortest sequence.
1835 Note that this case is only used once per constant. */
1836 struct mips_integer_op alt_codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1837 unsigned int cost, alt_cost;
1839 cost = mips_build_shift (codes, value);
1840 alt_cost = mips_build_lower (alt_codes, value);
1841 if (alt_cost < cost)
1843 memcpy (codes, alt_codes, alt_cost * sizeof (codes[0]));
1844 cost = alt_cost;
1846 return cost;
1851 /* Move VALUE into register DEST. */
1853 static void
1854 mips_move_integer (rtx dest, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1856 struct mips_integer_op codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1857 enum machine_mode mode;
1858 unsigned int i, cost;
1859 rtx x;
1861 mode = GET_MODE (dest);
1862 cost = mips_build_integer (codes, value);
1864 /* Apply each binary operation to X. Invariant: X is a legitimate
1865 source operand for a SET pattern. */
1866 x = GEN_INT (codes[0].value);
1867 for (i = 1; i < cost; i++)
1869 if (no_new_pseudos)
1870 emit_move_insn (dest, x), x = dest;
1871 else
1872 x = force_reg (mode, x);
1873 x = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (codes[i].code, mode, x, GEN_INT (codes[i].value));
1876 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, x));
1880 /* Subroutine of mips_legitimize_move. Move constant SRC into register
1881 DEST given that SRC satisfies immediate_operand but doesn't satisfy
1882 move_operand. */
1884 static void
1885 mips_legitimize_const_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
1887 rtx base;
1888 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1889 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1891 /* Split moves of big integers into smaller pieces. In mips16 code,
1892 it's better to force the constant into memory instead. */
1893 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT && !TARGET_MIPS16)
1895 mips_move_integer (dest, INTVAL (src));
1896 return;
1899 /* See if the symbol can be split. For mips16, this is often worse than
1900 forcing it in the constant pool since it needs the single-register form
1901 of addiu or daddiu. */
1902 if (!TARGET_MIPS16
1903 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (src, &symbol_type)
1904 && mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1906 emit_move_insn (dest, mips_split_symbol (dest, src));
1907 return;
1910 /* If we have (const (plus symbol offset)), load the symbol first
1911 and then add in the offset. This is usually better than forcing
1912 the constant into memory, at least in non-mips16 code. */
1913 mips_split_const (src, &base, &offset);
1914 if (!TARGET_MIPS16
1915 && offset != 0
1916 && (!no_new_pseudos || SMALL_OPERAND (offset)))
1918 base = mips_force_temporary (dest, base);
1919 emit_move_insn (dest, mips_add_offset (base, offset));
1920 return;
1923 src = force_const_mem (mode, src);
1925 /* When using explicit relocs, constant pool references are sometimes
1926 not legitimate addresses. */
1927 if (!memory_operand (src, VOIDmode))
1928 src = replace_equiv_address (src, mips_split_symbol (dest, XEXP (src, 0)));
1929 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
1933 /* If (set DEST SRC) is not a valid instruction, emit an equivalent
1934 sequence that is valid. */
1936 bool
1937 mips_legitimize_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
1939 if (!register_operand (dest, mode) && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
1941 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (mode, src));
1942 return true;
1945 /* The source of an SImode move must be a move_operand. Likewise
1946 DImode moves on 64-bit targets. We need to deal with constants
1947 that would be legitimate immediate_operands but not legitimate
1948 move_operands. */
1949 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
1950 && CONSTANT_P (src)
1951 && !move_operand (src, mode))
1953 mips_legitimize_const_move (mode, dest, src);
1954 set_unique_reg_note (get_last_insn (), REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (src));
1955 return true;
1957 return false;
1960 /* We need a lot of little routines to check constant values on the
1961 mips16. These are used to figure out how long the instruction will
1962 be. It would be much better to do this using constraints, but
1963 there aren't nearly enough letters available. */
1965 static int
1966 m16_check_op (rtx op, int low, int high, int mask)
1968 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
1969 && INTVAL (op) >= low
1970 && INTVAL (op) <= high
1971 && (INTVAL (op) & mask) == 0);
1975 m16_uimm3_b (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1977 return m16_check_op (op, 0x1, 0x8, 0);
1981 m16_simm4_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1983 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x8, 0x7, 0);
1987 m16_nsimm4_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1989 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x7, 0x8, 0);
1993 m16_simm5_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1995 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x10, 0xf, 0);
1999 m16_nsimm5_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2001 return m16_check_op (op, - 0xf, 0x10, 0);
2005 m16_uimm5_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2007 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x10) << 2, 0xf << 2, 3);
2011 m16_nuimm5_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2013 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0xf) << 2, 0x10 << 2, 3);
2017 m16_simm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2019 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x80, 0x7f, 0);
2023 m16_nsimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2025 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x7f, 0x80, 0);
2029 m16_uimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2031 return m16_check_op (op, 0x0, 0xff, 0);
2035 m16_nuimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2037 return m16_check_op (op, - 0xff, 0x0, 0);
2041 m16_uimm8_m1_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2043 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x1, 0xfe, 0);
2047 m16_uimm8_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2049 return m16_check_op (op, 0x0, 0xff << 2, 3);
2053 m16_nuimm8_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2055 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0xff) << 2, 0x0, 3);
2059 m16_simm8_8 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2061 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x80) << 3, 0x7f << 3, 7);
2065 m16_nsimm8_8 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2067 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x7f) << 3, 0x80 << 3, 7);
2070 /* References to the string table on the mips16 only use a small
2071 offset if the function is small. We can't check for LABEL_REF here,
2072 because the offset is always large if the label is before the
2073 referencing instruction. */
2076 m16_usym8_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2078 if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF
2079 && SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (op)
2080 && cfun->machine->insns_len > 0
2081 && INTERNAL_SYMBOL_P (op)
2082 && (cfun->machine->insns_len + get_pool_size () + mips_string_length
2083 < 4 * 0x100))
2085 struct string_constant *l;
2087 /* Make sure this symbol is on thelist of string constants to be
2088 output for this function. It is possible that it has already
2089 been output, in which case this requires a large offset. */
2090 for (l = string_constants; l != NULL; l = l->next)
2091 if (strcmp (l->label, XSTR (op, 0)) == 0)
2092 return 1;
2095 return 0;
2099 m16_usym5_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2101 if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF
2102 && SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (op)
2103 && cfun->machine->insns_len > 0
2104 && INTERNAL_SYMBOL_P (op)
2105 && (cfun->machine->insns_len + get_pool_size () + mips_string_length
2106 < 4 * 0x20))
2108 struct string_constant *l;
2110 /* Make sure this symbol is on thelist of string constants to be
2111 output for this function. It is possible that it has already
2112 been output, in which case this requires a large offset. */
2113 for (l = string_constants; l != NULL; l = l->next)
2114 if (strcmp (l->label, XSTR (op, 0)) == 0)
2115 return 1;
2118 return 0;
2121 static bool
2122 mips_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
2124 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2126 switch (code)
2128 case CONST_INT:
2129 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
2131 /* Always return 0, since we don't have different sized
2132 instructions, hence different costs according to Richard
2133 Kenner */
2134 *total = 0;
2135 return true;
2138 /* A number between 1 and 8 inclusive is efficient for a shift.
2139 Otherwise, we will need an extended instruction. */
2140 if ((outer_code) == ASHIFT || (outer_code) == ASHIFTRT
2141 || (outer_code) == LSHIFTRT)
2143 if (INTVAL (x) >= 1 && INTVAL (x) <= 8)
2144 *total = 0;
2145 else
2146 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2147 return true;
2150 /* We can use cmpi for an xor with an unsigned 16 bit value. */
2151 if ((outer_code) == XOR
2152 && INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 0x10000)
2154 *total = 0;
2155 return true;
2158 /* We may be able to use slt or sltu for a comparison with a
2159 signed 16 bit value. (The boundary conditions aren't quite
2160 right, but this is just a heuristic anyhow.) */
2161 if (((outer_code) == LT || (outer_code) == LE
2162 || (outer_code) == GE || (outer_code) == GT
2163 || (outer_code) == LTU || (outer_code) == LEU
2164 || (outer_code) == GEU || (outer_code) == GTU)
2165 && INTVAL (x) >= -0x8000 && INTVAL (x) < 0x8000)
2167 *total = 0;
2168 return true;
2171 /* Equality comparisons with 0 are cheap. */
2172 if (((outer_code) == EQ || (outer_code) == NE)
2173 && INTVAL (x) == 0)
2175 *total = 0;
2176 return true;
2179 /* Otherwise fall through to the handling below. */
2181 case CONST:
2182 case SYMBOL_REF:
2183 case LABEL_REF:
2184 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2185 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
2187 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2188 return true;
2190 else
2192 /* The value will need to be fetched from the constant pool. */
2193 *total = CONSTANT_POOL_COST;
2194 return true;
2197 case MEM:
2199 /* If the address is legitimate, return the number of
2200 instructions it needs, otherwise use the default handling. */
2201 int n = mips_address_insns (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
2202 if (n > 0)
2204 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + n);
2205 return true;
2207 return false;
2210 case FFS:
2211 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
2212 return true;
2214 case NOT:
2215 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT) ? 2 : 1);
2216 return true;
2218 case AND:
2219 case IOR:
2220 case XOR:
2221 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2223 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2224 return true;
2226 return false;
2228 case ASHIFT:
2229 case ASHIFTRT:
2230 case LSHIFTRT:
2231 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2233 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2234 ? 4 : 12);
2235 return true;
2237 return false;
2239 case ABS:
2240 if (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode)
2241 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2242 else
2243 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2244 return true;
2246 case LO_SUM:
2247 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2248 return true;
2250 case PLUS:
2251 case MINUS:
2252 if (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode)
2254 if (TUNE_MIPS3000 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2255 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2256 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2257 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
2258 else
2259 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
2260 return true;
2262 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2264 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2265 return true;
2267 return false;
2269 case NEG:
2270 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2272 *total = 4;
2273 return true;
2275 return false;
2277 case MULT:
2278 if (mode == SFmode)
2280 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2281 || TUNE_MIPS3900
2282 || TUNE_MIPS5000)
2283 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2284 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000
2285 || TUNE_MIPS5400
2286 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2287 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2288 else
2289 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (7);
2290 return true;
2293 if (mode == DFmode)
2295 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2296 || TUNE_MIPS3900
2297 || TUNE_MIPS5000)
2298 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2299 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000
2300 || TUNE_MIPS5400
2301 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2302 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
2303 else
2304 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (8);
2305 return true;
2308 if (TUNE_MIPS3000)
2309 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (12);
2310 else if (TUNE_MIPS3900)
2311 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2312 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2313 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == DImode) ? 4 : 3);
2314 else if (TUNE_MIPS7000)
2315 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 9 : 5);
2316 else if (TUNE_MIPS9000)
2317 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 8 : 3);
2318 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2319 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (17);
2320 else if (TUNE_MIPS5000)
2321 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2322 else
2323 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (10);
2324 return true;
2326 case DIV:
2327 case MOD:
2328 if (mode == SFmode)
2330 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2331 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2332 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (12);
2333 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2334 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (15);
2335 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2336 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (30);
2337 else
2338 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (23);
2339 return true;
2342 if (mode == DFmode)
2344 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2345 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2346 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (19);
2347 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2348 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (59);
2349 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2350 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (16);
2351 else
2352 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (36);
2353 return true;
2355 /* FALLTHRU */
2357 case UDIV:
2358 case UMOD:
2359 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2360 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2361 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (35);
2362 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2363 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (38);
2364 else if (TUNE_MIPS5000)
2365 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (36);
2366 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2367 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == SImode) ? 42 : 74);
2368 else
2369 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (69);
2370 return true;
2372 case SIGN_EXTEND:
2373 /* A sign extend from SImode to DImode in 64 bit mode is often
2374 zero instructions, because the result can often be used
2375 directly by another instruction; we'll call it one. */
2376 if (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode
2377 && GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SImode)
2378 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2379 else
2380 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2381 return true;
2383 case ZERO_EXTEND:
2384 if (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode
2385 && GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SImode)
2386 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2387 else
2388 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2389 return true;
2391 default:
2392 return false;
2396 /* Provide the costs of an addressing mode that contains ADDR.
2397 If ADDR is not a valid address, its cost is irrelevant. */
2399 static int
2400 mips_address_cost (rtx addr)
2402 return mips_address_insns (addr, SImode);
2405 /* Return a pseudo that points to the address of the current function.
2406 The first time it is called for a function, an initializer for the
2407 pseudo is emitted in the beginning of the function. */
2410 embedded_pic_fnaddr_reg (void)
2412 if (cfun->machine->embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx == NULL)
2414 rtx seq;
2416 cfun->machine->embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
2418 /* Output code at function start to initialize the pseudo-reg. */
2419 /* ??? We used to do this in FINALIZE_PIC, but that does not work for
2420 inline functions, because it is called after RTL for the function
2421 has been copied. The pseudo-reg in embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx however
2422 does not get copied, and ends up not matching the rest of the RTL.
2423 This solution works, but means that we get unnecessary code to
2424 initialize this value every time a function is inlined into another
2425 function. */
2426 start_sequence ();
2427 emit_insn (gen_get_fnaddr (cfun->machine->embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx,
2428 XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0)));
2429 seq = get_insns ();
2430 end_sequence ();
2431 push_topmost_sequence ();
2432 emit_insn_after (seq, get_insns ());
2433 pop_topmost_sequence ();
2436 return cfun->machine->embedded_pic_fnaddr_rtx;
2439 /* Return RTL for the offset from the current function to the argument.
2440 X is the symbol whose offset from the current function we want. */
2443 embedded_pic_offset (rtx x)
2445 /* Make sure it is emitted. */
2446 embedded_pic_fnaddr_reg ();
2448 return
2449 gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode,
2450 gen_rtx_MINUS (Pmode, x,
2451 XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0)));
2454 /* Return one word of double-word value OP, taking into account the fixed
2455 endianness of certain registers. HIGH_P is true to select the high part,
2456 false to select the low part. */
2459 mips_subword (rtx op, int high_p)
2461 unsigned int byte;
2462 enum machine_mode mode;
2464 mode = GET_MODE (op);
2465 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2466 mode = DImode;
2468 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN ? !high_p : high_p)
2469 byte = UNITS_PER_WORD;
2470 else
2471 byte = 0;
2473 if (GET_CODE (op) == REG)
2475 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (op)))
2476 return gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, high_p ? REGNO (op) + 1 : REGNO (op));
2477 if (REGNO (op) == HI_REGNUM)
2478 return gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, high_p ? HI_REGNUM : LO_REGNUM);
2481 if (GET_CODE (op) == MEM)
2482 return mips_rewrite_small_data (adjust_address (op, word_mode, byte));
2484 return simplify_gen_subreg (word_mode, op, mode, byte);
2488 /* Return true if a 64-bit move from SRC to DEST should be split into two. */
2490 bool
2491 mips_split_64bit_move_p (rtx dest, rtx src)
2493 if (TARGET_64BIT)
2494 return false;
2496 /* FP->FP moves can be done in a single instruction. */
2497 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src) && FP_REG_RTX_P (dest))
2498 return false;
2500 /* Check for floating-point loads and stores. They can be done using
2501 ldc1 and sdc1 on MIPS II and above. */
2502 if (mips_isa > 1)
2504 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (dest) && GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
2505 return false;
2506 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src) && GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
2507 return false;
2509 return true;
2513 /* Split a 64-bit move from SRC to DEST assuming that
2514 mips_split_64bit_move_p holds.
2516 Moves into and out of FPRs cause some difficulty here. Such moves
2517 will always be DFmode, since paired FPRs are not allowed to store
2518 DImode values. The most natural representation would be two separate
2519 32-bit moves, such as:
2521 (set (reg:SI $f0) (mem:SI ...))
2522 (set (reg:SI $f1) (mem:SI ...))
2524 However, the second insn is invalid because odd-numbered FPRs are
2525 not allowed to store independent values. Use the patterns load_df_low,
2526 load_df_high and store_df_high instead. */
2528 void
2529 mips_split_64bit_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
2531 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (dest))
2533 /* Loading an FPR from memory or from GPRs. */
2534 emit_insn (gen_load_df_low (copy_rtx (dest), mips_subword (src, 0)));
2535 emit_insn (gen_load_df_high (dest, mips_subword (src, 1),
2536 copy_rtx (dest)));
2538 else if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src))
2540 /* Storing an FPR into memory or GPRs. */
2541 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 0), mips_subword (src, 0));
2542 emit_insn (gen_store_df_high (mips_subword (dest, 1), src));
2544 else
2546 /* The operation can be split into two normal moves. Decide in
2547 which order to do them. */
2548 rtx low_dest;
2550 low_dest = mips_subword (dest, 0);
2551 if (GET_CODE (low_dest) == REG
2552 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (low_dest, src))
2554 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 1), mips_subword (src, 1));
2555 emit_move_insn (low_dest, mips_subword (src, 0));
2557 else
2559 emit_move_insn (low_dest, mips_subword (src, 0));
2560 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 1), mips_subword (src, 1));
2565 /* Return the appropriate instructions to move SRC into DEST. Assume
2566 that SRC is operand 1 and DEST is operand 0. */
2568 const char *
2569 mips_output_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
2571 enum rtx_code dest_code, src_code;
2572 bool dbl_p;
2574 dest_code = GET_CODE (dest);
2575 src_code = GET_CODE (src);
2576 dbl_p = (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) == 8);
2578 if (dbl_p && mips_split_64bit_move_p (dest, src))
2579 return "#";
2581 if ((src_code == REG && GP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2582 || (!TARGET_MIPS16 && src == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (dest))))
2584 if (dest_code == REG)
2586 if (GP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2587 return "move\t%0,%z1";
2589 if (MD_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2590 return "mt%0\t%z1";
2592 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2593 return (dbl_p ? "dmtc1\t%z1,%0" : "mtc1\t%z1,%0");
2595 if (ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2597 static char retval[] = "dmtc_\t%z1,%0";
2599 retval[4] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
2600 return (dbl_p ? retval : retval + 1);
2603 if (dest_code == MEM)
2604 return (dbl_p ? "sd\t%z1,%0" : "sw\t%z1,%0");
2606 if (dest_code == REG && GP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2608 if (src_code == REG)
2610 if (MD_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2611 return "mf%1\t%0";
2613 if (ST_REG_P (REGNO (src)) && ISA_HAS_8CC)
2614 return "lui\t%0,0x3f80\n\tmovf\t%0,%.,%1";
2616 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2617 return (dbl_p ? "dmfc1\t%0,%1" : "mfc1\t%0,%1");
2619 if (ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2621 static char retval[] = "dmfc_\t%0,%1";
2623 retval[4] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2624 return (dbl_p ? retval : retval + 1);
2628 if (src_code == MEM)
2629 return (dbl_p ? "ld\t%0,%1" : "lw\t%0,%1");
2631 if (src_code == CONST_INT)
2633 /* Don't use the X format, because that will give out of
2634 range numbers for 64 bit hosts and 32 bit targets. */
2635 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
2636 return "li\t%0,%1\t\t\t# %X1";
2638 if (INTVAL (src) >= 0 && INTVAL (src) <= 0xffff)
2639 return "li\t%0,%1";
2641 if (INTVAL (src) < 0 && INTVAL (src) >= -0xffff)
2642 return "li\t%0,%n1\n\tneg\t%0";
2645 if (src_code == HIGH)
2646 return "lui\t%0,%h1";
2648 if (CONST_GP_P (src))
2649 return "move\t%0,%1";
2651 if (symbolic_operand (src, VOIDmode))
2652 return (dbl_p ? "dla\t%0,%1" : "la\t%0,%1");
2654 if (src_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2656 if (dest_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2657 return (dbl_p ? "mov.d\t%0,%1" : "mov.s\t%0,%1");
2659 if (dest_code == MEM)
2660 return (dbl_p ? "sdc1\t%1,%0" : "swc1\t%1,%0");
2662 if (dest_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2664 if (src_code == MEM)
2665 return (dbl_p ? "ldc1\t%0,%1" : "lwc1\t%0,%1");
2667 if (dest_code == REG && ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)) && src_code == MEM)
2669 static char retval[] = "l_c_\t%0,%1";
2671 retval[1] = (dbl_p ? 'd' : 'w');
2672 retval[3] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
2673 return retval;
2675 if (dest_code == MEM && src_code == REG && ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2677 static char retval[] = "s_c_\t%1,%0";
2679 retval[1] = (dbl_p ? 'd' : 'w');
2680 retval[3] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2681 return retval;
2683 abort ();
2686 /* Return an rtx for the gp save slot. Valid only when using o32 or
2687 o64 abicalls. */
2690 mips_gp_save_slot (void)
2692 rtx loc;
2694 if (!TARGET_ABICALLS || TARGET_NEWABI)
2695 abort ();
2697 if (frame_pointer_needed)
2698 loc = hard_frame_pointer_rtx;
2699 else
2700 loc = stack_pointer_rtx;
2701 loc = plus_constant (loc, current_function_outgoing_args_size);
2702 loc = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, loc);
2703 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (loc) = 1;
2704 return loc;
2707 /* Make normal rtx_code into something we can index from an array */
2709 static enum internal_test
2710 map_test_to_internal_test (enum rtx_code test_code)
2712 enum internal_test test = ITEST_MAX;
2714 switch (test_code)
2716 case EQ: test = ITEST_EQ; break;
2717 case NE: test = ITEST_NE; break;
2718 case GT: test = ITEST_GT; break;
2719 case GE: test = ITEST_GE; break;
2720 case LT: test = ITEST_LT; break;
2721 case LE: test = ITEST_LE; break;
2722 case GTU: test = ITEST_GTU; break;
2723 case GEU: test = ITEST_GEU; break;
2724 case LTU: test = ITEST_LTU; break;
2725 case LEU: test = ITEST_LEU; break;
2726 default: break;
2729 return test;
2733 /* Generate the code to compare two integer values. The return value is:
2734 (reg:SI xx) The pseudo register the comparison is in
2735 0 No register, generate a simple branch.
2737 ??? This is called with result nonzero by the Scond patterns in
2738 mips.md. These patterns are called with a target in the mode of
2739 the Scond instruction pattern. Since this must be a constant, we
2740 must use SImode. This means that if RESULT is nonzero, it will
2741 always be an SImode register, even if TARGET_64BIT is true. We
2742 cope with this by calling convert_move rather than emit_move_insn.
2743 This will sometimes lead to an unnecessary extension of the result;
2744 for example:
2746 long long
2747 foo (long long i)
2749 return i < 5;
2752 TEST_CODE is the rtx code for the comparison.
2753 CMP0 and CMP1 are the two operands to compare.
2754 RESULT is the register in which the result should be stored (null for
2755 branches).
2756 For branches, P_INVERT points to an integer that is nonzero on return
2757 if the branch should be inverted. */
2760 gen_int_relational (enum rtx_code test_code, rtx result, rtx cmp0,
2761 rtx cmp1, int *p_invert)
2763 struct cmp_info
2765 enum rtx_code test_code; /* code to use in instruction (LT vs. LTU) */
2766 int const_low; /* low bound of constant we can accept */
2767 int const_high; /* high bound of constant we can accept */
2768 int const_add; /* constant to add (convert LE -> LT) */
2769 int reverse_regs; /* reverse registers in test */
2770 int invert_const; /* != 0 if invert value if cmp1 is constant */
2771 int invert_reg; /* != 0 if invert value if cmp1 is register */
2772 int unsignedp; /* != 0 for unsigned comparisons. */
2775 static const struct cmp_info info[ (int)ITEST_MAX ] = {
2777 { XOR, 0, 65535, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* EQ */
2778 { XOR, 0, 65535, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0 }, /* NE */
2779 { LT, -32769, 32766, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0 }, /* GT */
2780 { LT, -32768, 32767, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0 }, /* GE */
2781 { LT, -32768, 32767, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* LT */
2782 { LT, -32769, 32766, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0 }, /* LE */
2783 { LTU, -32769, 32766, 1, 1, 1, 0, 1 }, /* GTU */
2784 { LTU, -32768, 32767, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1 }, /* GEU */
2785 { LTU, -32768, 32767, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1 }, /* LTU */
2786 { LTU, -32769, 32766, 1, 1, 0, 1, 1 }, /* LEU */
2789 enum internal_test test;
2790 enum machine_mode mode;
2791 const struct cmp_info *p_info;
2792 int branch_p;
2793 int eqne_p;
2794 int invert;
2795 rtx reg;
2796 rtx reg2;
2798 test = map_test_to_internal_test (test_code);
2799 if (test == ITEST_MAX)
2800 abort ();
2802 p_info = &info[(int) test];
2803 eqne_p = (p_info->test_code == XOR);
2805 mode = GET_MODE (cmp0);
2806 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2807 mode = GET_MODE (cmp1);
2809 /* Eliminate simple branches */
2810 branch_p = (result == 0);
2811 if (branch_p)
2813 if (GET_CODE (cmp0) == REG || GET_CODE (cmp0) == SUBREG)
2815 /* Comparisons against zero are simple branches */
2816 if (GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (cmp1) == 0
2817 && (! TARGET_MIPS16 || eqne_p))
2818 return 0;
2820 /* Test for beq/bne. */
2821 if (eqne_p && ! TARGET_MIPS16)
2822 return 0;
2825 /* allocate a pseudo to calculate the value in. */
2826 result = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2829 /* Make sure we can handle any constants given to us. */
2830 if (GET_CODE (cmp0) == CONST_INT)
2831 cmp0 = force_reg (mode, cmp0);
2833 if (GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT)
2835 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (cmp1);
2837 if (value < p_info->const_low
2838 || value > p_info->const_high
2839 /* ??? Why? And why wasn't the similar code below modified too? */
2840 || (TARGET_64BIT
2841 && HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64
2842 && p_info->const_add != 0
2843 && ((p_info->unsignedp
2844 ? ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (value + p_info->const_add)
2845 > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (cmp1))
2846 : (value + p_info->const_add) > INTVAL (cmp1))
2847 != (p_info->const_add > 0))))
2848 cmp1 = force_reg (mode, cmp1);
2851 /* See if we need to invert the result. */
2852 invert = (GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT
2853 ? p_info->invert_const : p_info->invert_reg);
2855 if (p_invert != (int *)0)
2857 *p_invert = invert;
2858 invert = 0;
2861 /* Comparison to constants, may involve adding 1 to change a LT into LE.
2862 Comparison between two registers, may involve switching operands. */
2863 if (GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT)
2865 if (p_info->const_add != 0)
2867 HOST_WIDE_INT new = INTVAL (cmp1) + p_info->const_add;
2869 /* If modification of cmp1 caused overflow,
2870 we would get the wrong answer if we follow the usual path;
2871 thus, x > 0xffffffffU would turn into x > 0U. */
2872 if ((p_info->unsignedp
2873 ? (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) new >
2874 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (cmp1)
2875 : new > INTVAL (cmp1))
2876 != (p_info->const_add > 0))
2878 /* This test is always true, but if INVERT is true then
2879 the result of the test needs to be inverted so 0 should
2880 be returned instead. */
2881 emit_move_insn (result, invert ? const0_rtx : const_true_rtx);
2882 return result;
2884 else
2885 cmp1 = GEN_INT (new);
2889 else if (p_info->reverse_regs)
2891 rtx temp = cmp0;
2892 cmp0 = cmp1;
2893 cmp1 = temp;
2896 if (test == ITEST_NE && GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (cmp1) == 0)
2897 reg = cmp0;
2898 else
2900 reg = (invert || eqne_p) ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : result;
2901 convert_move (reg, gen_rtx (p_info->test_code, mode, cmp0, cmp1), 0);
2904 if (test == ITEST_NE)
2906 if (! TARGET_MIPS16)
2908 convert_move (result, gen_rtx (GTU, mode, reg, const0_rtx), 0);
2909 if (p_invert != NULL)
2910 *p_invert = 0;
2911 invert = 0;
2913 else
2915 reg2 = invert ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : result;
2916 convert_move (reg2, gen_rtx (LTU, mode, reg, const1_rtx), 0);
2917 reg = reg2;
2921 else if (test == ITEST_EQ)
2923 reg2 = invert ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : result;
2924 convert_move (reg2, gen_rtx_LTU (mode, reg, const1_rtx), 0);
2925 reg = reg2;
2928 if (invert)
2930 rtx one;
2932 if (! TARGET_MIPS16)
2933 one = const1_rtx;
2934 else
2936 /* The value is in $24. Copy it to another register, so
2937 that reload doesn't think it needs to store the $24 and
2938 the input to the XOR in the same location. */
2939 reg2 = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2940 emit_move_insn (reg2, reg);
2941 reg = reg2;
2942 one = force_reg (mode, const1_rtx);
2944 convert_move (result, gen_rtx (XOR, mode, reg, one), 0);
2947 return result;
2950 /* Work out how to check a floating-point condition. We need a
2951 separate comparison instruction (C.cond.fmt), followed by a
2952 branch or conditional move. Given that IN_CODE is the
2953 required condition, set *CMP_CODE to the C.cond.fmt code
2954 and *action_code to the branch or move code. */
2956 static void
2957 get_float_compare_codes (enum rtx_code in_code, enum rtx_code *cmp_code,
2958 enum rtx_code *action_code)
2960 switch (in_code)
2962 case NE:
2963 case UNGE:
2964 case UNGT:
2965 case LTGT:
2966 case ORDERED:
2967 *cmp_code = reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (in_code);
2968 *action_code = EQ;
2969 break;
2971 default:
2972 *cmp_code = in_code;
2973 *action_code = NE;
2974 break;
2978 /* Emit the common code for doing conditional branches.
2979 operand[0] is the label to jump to.
2980 The comparison operands are saved away by cmp{si,di,sf,df}. */
2982 void
2983 gen_conditional_branch (rtx *operands, enum rtx_code test_code)
2985 enum cmp_type type = branch_type;
2986 rtx cmp0 = branch_cmp[0];
2987 rtx cmp1 = branch_cmp[1];
2988 enum machine_mode mode;
2989 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
2990 rtx reg;
2991 int invert;
2992 rtx label1, label2;
2994 switch (type)
2996 case CMP_SI:
2997 case CMP_DI:
2998 mode = type == CMP_SI ? SImode : DImode;
2999 invert = 0;
3000 reg = gen_int_relational (test_code, NULL_RTX, cmp0, cmp1, &invert);
3002 if (reg)
3004 cmp0 = reg;
3005 cmp1 = const0_rtx;
3006 test_code = NE;
3008 else if (GET_CODE (cmp1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (cmp1) != 0)
3009 /* We don't want to build a comparison against a nonzero
3010 constant. */
3011 cmp1 = force_reg (mode, cmp1);
3013 break;
3015 case CMP_SF:
3016 case CMP_DF:
3017 if (! ISA_HAS_8CC)
3018 reg = gen_rtx_REG (CCmode, FPSW_REGNUM);
3019 else
3020 reg = gen_reg_rtx (CCmode);
3022 get_float_compare_codes (test_code, &cmp_code, &test_code);
3023 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3024 gen_rtx (cmp_code, CCmode, cmp0, cmp1)));
3026 mode = CCmode;
3027 cmp0 = reg;
3028 cmp1 = const0_rtx;
3029 invert = 0;
3030 break;
3032 default:
3033 fatal_insn ("bad test", gen_rtx (test_code, VOIDmode, cmp0, cmp1));
3036 /* Generate the branch. */
3038 label1 = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, operands[0]);
3039 label2 = pc_rtx;
3041 if (invert)
3043 label2 = label1;
3044 label1 = pc_rtx;
3047 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx,
3048 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode,
3049 gen_rtx (test_code, mode,
3050 cmp0, cmp1),
3051 label1, label2)));
3054 /* Emit the common code for conditional moves. OPERANDS is the array
3055 of operands passed to the conditional move define_expand. */
3057 void
3058 gen_conditional_move (rtx *operands)
3060 rtx op0 = branch_cmp[0];
3061 rtx op1 = branch_cmp[1];
3062 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (branch_cmp[0]);
3063 enum rtx_code cmp_code = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
3064 enum rtx_code move_code = NE;
3065 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (operands[0]);
3066 enum machine_mode cmp_mode;
3067 rtx cmp_reg;
3069 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_FLOAT)
3071 switch (cmp_code)
3073 case EQ:
3074 cmp_code = XOR;
3075 move_code = EQ;
3076 break;
3077 case NE:
3078 cmp_code = XOR;
3079 break;
3080 case LT:
3081 break;
3082 case GE:
3083 cmp_code = LT;
3084 move_code = EQ;
3085 break;
3086 case GT:
3087 cmp_code = LT;
3088 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[1]);
3089 op1 = branch_cmp[0];
3090 break;
3091 case LE:
3092 cmp_code = LT;
3093 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[1]);
3094 op1 = branch_cmp[0];
3095 move_code = EQ;
3096 break;
3097 case LTU:
3098 break;
3099 case GEU:
3100 cmp_code = LTU;
3101 move_code = EQ;
3102 break;
3103 case GTU:
3104 cmp_code = LTU;
3105 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[1]);
3106 op1 = branch_cmp[0];
3107 break;
3108 case LEU:
3109 cmp_code = LTU;
3110 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[1]);
3111 op1 = branch_cmp[0];
3112 move_code = EQ;
3113 break;
3114 default:
3115 abort ();
3118 else
3119 get_float_compare_codes (cmp_code, &cmp_code, &move_code);
3121 if (mode == SImode || mode == DImode)
3122 cmp_mode = mode;
3123 else if (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode)
3124 cmp_mode = CCmode;
3125 else
3126 abort ();
3128 cmp_reg = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
3129 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (cmp_mode, cmp_reg,
3130 gen_rtx (cmp_code, cmp_mode, op0, op1)));
3132 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (op_mode, operands[0],
3133 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (op_mode,
3134 gen_rtx (move_code, VOIDmode,
3135 cmp_reg,
3136 CONST0_RTX (SImode)),
3137 operands[2], operands[3])));
3140 /* Emit a conditional trap. OPERANDS is the array of operands passed to
3141 the conditional_trap expander. */
3143 void
3144 mips_gen_conditional_trap (rtx *operands)
3146 rtx op0, op1;
3147 enum rtx_code cmp_code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
3148 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (branch_cmp[0]);
3150 /* MIPS conditional trap machine instructions don't have GT or LE
3151 flavors, so we must invert the comparison and convert to LT and
3152 GE, respectively. */
3153 switch (cmp_code)
3155 case GT: cmp_code = LT; break;
3156 case LE: cmp_code = GE; break;
3157 case GTU: cmp_code = LTU; break;
3158 case LEU: cmp_code = GEU; break;
3159 default: break;
3161 if (cmp_code == GET_CODE (operands[0]))
3163 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[0]);
3164 op1 = branch_cmp[1];
3166 else
3168 op0 = force_reg (mode, branch_cmp[1]);
3169 op1 = branch_cmp[0];
3171 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT && ! SMALL_INT (op1))
3172 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
3174 emit_insn (gen_rtx_TRAP_IF (VOIDmode,
3175 gen_rtx (cmp_code, GET_MODE (operands[0]), op0, op1),
3176 operands[1]));
3179 /* Expand a call or call_value instruction. RESULT is where the
3180 result will go (null for calls), ADDR is the address of the
3181 function, ARGS_SIZE is the size of the arguments and AUX is
3182 the value passed to us by mips_function_arg. SIBCALL_P is true
3183 if we are expanding a sibling call, false if we're expanding
3184 a normal call. */
3186 void
3187 mips_expand_call (rtx result, rtx addr, rtx args_size, rtx aux, int sibcall_p)
3189 if (!call_insn_operand (addr, VOIDmode))
3191 /* If we're generating PIC, and this call is to a global function,
3192 try to allow its address to be resolved lazily. This isn't
3193 possible for NewABI sibcalls since the value of $gp on entry
3194 to the stub would be our caller's gp, not ours. */
3195 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
3196 && !(sibcall_p && TARGET_NEWABI)
3197 && global_got_operand (addr, VOIDmode))
3199 rtx high, lo_sum_symbol;
3201 high = mips_unspec_offset_high (pic_offset_table_rtx,
3202 addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL);
3203 lo_sum_symbol = mips_unspec_address (addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL);
3204 addr = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3205 if (Pmode == SImode)
3206 emit_insn (gen_load_callsi (addr, high, lo_sum_symbol));
3207 else
3208 emit_insn (gen_load_calldi (addr, high, lo_sum_symbol));
3210 else
3211 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
3214 if (TARGET_MIPS16
3215 && mips16_hard_float
3216 && build_mips16_call_stub (result, addr, args_size,
3217 aux == 0 ? 0 : (int) GET_MODE (aux)))
3218 /* Nothing more to do */;
3219 else if (result == 0)
3220 emit_call_insn (sibcall_p
3221 ? gen_sibcall_internal (addr, args_size)
3222 : gen_call_internal (addr, args_size));
3223 else if (GET_CODE (result) == PARALLEL && XVECLEN (result, 0) == 2)
3225 rtx reg1, reg2;
3227 reg1 = XEXP (XVECEXP (result, 0, 0), 0);
3228 reg2 = XEXP (XVECEXP (result, 0, 1), 0);
3229 emit_call_insn
3230 (sibcall_p
3231 ? gen_sibcall_value_multiple_internal (reg1, addr, args_size, reg2)
3232 : gen_call_value_multiple_internal (reg1, addr, args_size, reg2));
3234 else
3235 emit_call_insn (sibcall_p
3236 ? gen_sibcall_value_internal (result, addr, args_size)
3237 : gen_call_value_internal (result, addr, args_size));
3241 /* We can handle any sibcall when TARGET_SIBCALLS is true. */
3243 static bool
3244 mips_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3245 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3247 return TARGET_SIBCALLS;
3250 /* Return true if operand OP is a condition code register.
3251 Only for use during or after reload. */
3254 fcc_register_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
3256 return ((mode == VOIDmode || mode == GET_MODE (op))
3257 && (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3258 && (GET_CODE (op) == REG || GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
3259 && ST_REG_P (true_regnum (op)));
3262 /* Emit code to move general operand SRC into condition-code
3263 register DEST. SCRATCH is a scratch TFmode float register.
3264 The sequence is:
3266 FP1 = SRC
3267 FP2 = 0.0f
3268 DEST = FP2 < FP1
3270 where FP1 and FP2 are single-precision float registers
3271 taken from SCRATCH. */
3273 void
3274 mips_emit_fcc_reload (rtx dest, rtx src, rtx scratch)
3276 rtx fp1, fp2;
3278 /* Change the source to SFmode. */
3279 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
3280 src = adjust_address (src, SFmode, 0);
3281 else if (GET_CODE (src) == REG || GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG)
3282 src = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, true_regnum (src));
3284 fp1 = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, REGNO (scratch));
3285 fp2 = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, REGNO (scratch) + FP_INC);
3287 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (fp1), src);
3288 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (fp2), CONST0_RTX (SFmode));
3289 emit_insn (gen_slt_sf (dest, fp2, fp1));
3292 /* Emit code to change the current function's return address to
3293 ADDRESS. SCRATCH is available as a scratch register, if needed.
3294 ADDRESS and SCRATCH are both word-mode GPRs. */
3296 void
3297 mips_set_return_address (rtx address, rtx scratch)
3299 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_offset;
3301 compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
3302 if (((cfun->machine->frame.mask >> 31) & 1) == 0)
3303 abort ();
3304 gp_offset = cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset;
3306 /* Reduce SP + GP_OFSET to a legitimate address and put it in SCRATCH. */
3307 if (gp_offset < 32768)
3308 scratch = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, gp_offset);
3309 else
3311 emit_move_insn (scratch, GEN_INT (gp_offset));
3312 if (Pmode == DImode)
3313 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (scratch, scratch, stack_pointer_rtx));
3314 else
3315 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (scratch, scratch, stack_pointer_rtx));
3318 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (address), scratch), address);
3321 /* Emit straight-line code to move LENGTH bytes from SRC to DEST.
3322 Assume that the areas do not overlap. */
3324 static void
3325 mips_block_move_straight (rtx dest, rtx src, HOST_WIDE_INT length)
3327 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, delta;
3328 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bits;
3329 int i;
3330 enum machine_mode mode;
3331 rtx *regs;
3333 /* Work out how many bits to move at a time. If both operands have
3334 half-word alignment, it is usually better to move in half words.
3335 For instance, lh/lh/sh/sh is usually better than lwl/lwr/swl/swr
3336 and lw/lw/sw/sw is usually better than ldl/ldr/sdl/sdr.
3337 Otherwise move word-sized chunks. */
3338 if (MEM_ALIGN (src) == BITS_PER_WORD / 2
3339 && MEM_ALIGN (dest) == BITS_PER_WORD / 2)
3340 bits = BITS_PER_WORD / 2;
3341 else
3342 bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
3344 mode = mode_for_size (bits, MODE_INT, 0);
3345 delta = bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
3347 /* Allocate a buffer for the temporary registers. */
3348 regs = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * length / delta);
3350 /* Load as many BITS-sized chunks as possible. Use a normal load if
3351 the source has enough alignment, otherwise use left/right pairs. */
3352 for (offset = 0, i = 0; offset + delta <= length; offset += delta, i++)
3354 rtx part;
3356 regs[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
3357 part = adjust_address (src, mode, offset);
3358 if (MEM_ALIGN (part) >= bits)
3359 emit_move_insn (regs[i], part);
3360 else if (!mips_expand_unaligned_load (regs[i], part, bits, 0))
3361 abort ();
3364 /* Copy the chunks to the destination. */
3365 for (offset = 0, i = 0; offset + delta <= length; offset += delta, i++)
3367 rtx part;
3369 part = adjust_address (dest, mode, offset);
3370 if (MEM_ALIGN (part) >= bits)
3371 emit_move_insn (part, regs[i]);
3372 else if (!mips_expand_unaligned_store (part, regs[i], bits, 0))
3373 abort ();
3376 /* Mop up any left-over bytes. */
3377 if (offset < length)
3379 src = adjust_address (src, mode, offset);
3380 dest = adjust_address (dest, mode, offset);
3381 move_by_pieces (dest, src, length - offset,
3382 MIN (MEM_ALIGN (src), MEM_ALIGN (dest)), 0);
3386 #define MAX_MOVE_REGS 4
3387 #define MAX_MOVE_BYTES (MAX_MOVE_REGS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
3390 /* Helper function for doing a loop-based block operation on memory
3391 reference MEM. Each iteration of the loop will operate on LENGTH
3392 bytes of MEM.
3394 Create a new base register for use within the loop and point it to
3395 the start of MEM. Create a new memory reference that uses this
3396 register. Store them in *LOOP_REG and *LOOP_MEM respectively. */
3398 static void
3399 mips_adjust_block_mem (rtx mem, HOST_WIDE_INT length,
3400 rtx *loop_reg, rtx *loop_mem)
3402 *loop_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (mem, 0));
3404 /* Although the new mem does not refer to a known location,
3405 it does keep up to LENGTH bytes of alignment. */
3406 *loop_mem = change_address (mem, BLKmode, *loop_reg);
3407 set_mem_align (*loop_mem, MIN (MEM_ALIGN (mem), length * BITS_PER_UNIT));
3411 /* Move LENGTH bytes from SRC to DEST using a loop that moves MAX_MOVE_BYTES
3412 per iteration. LENGTH must be at least MAX_MOVE_BYTES. Assume that the
3413 memory regions do not overlap. */
3415 static void
3416 mips_block_move_loop (rtx dest, rtx src, HOST_WIDE_INT length)
3418 rtx label, src_reg, dest_reg, final_src;
3419 HOST_WIDE_INT leftover;
3421 leftover = length % MAX_MOVE_BYTES;
3422 length -= leftover;
3424 /* Create registers and memory references for use within the loop. */
3425 mips_adjust_block_mem (src, MAX_MOVE_BYTES, &src_reg, &src);
3426 mips_adjust_block_mem (dest, MAX_MOVE_BYTES, &dest_reg, &dest);
3428 /* Calculate the value that SRC_REG should have after the last iteration
3429 of the loop. */
3430 final_src = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, src_reg, GEN_INT (length),
3431 0, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3433 /* Emit the start of the loop. */
3434 label = gen_label_rtx ();
3435 emit_label (label);
3437 /* Emit the loop body. */
3438 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, MAX_MOVE_BYTES);
3440 /* Move on to the next block. */
3441 emit_move_insn (src_reg, plus_constant (src_reg, MAX_MOVE_BYTES));
3442 emit_move_insn (dest_reg, plus_constant (dest_reg, MAX_MOVE_BYTES));
3444 /* Emit the loop condition. */
3445 if (Pmode == DImode)
3446 emit_insn (gen_cmpdi (src_reg, final_src));
3447 else
3448 emit_insn (gen_cmpsi (src_reg, final_src));
3449 emit_jump_insn (gen_bne (label));
3451 /* Mop up any left-over bytes. */
3452 if (leftover)
3453 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, leftover);
3456 /* Expand a movstrsi instruction. */
3458 bool
3459 mips_expand_block_move (rtx dest, rtx src, rtx length)
3461 if (GET_CODE (length) == CONST_INT)
3463 if (INTVAL (length) <= 2 * MAX_MOVE_BYTES)
3465 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, INTVAL (length));
3466 return true;
3468 else if (optimize)
3470 mips_block_move_loop (dest, src, INTVAL (length));
3471 return true;
3474 return false;
3477 /* Argument support functions. */
3479 /* Initialize CUMULATIVE_ARGS for a function. */
3481 void
3482 init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, tree fntype,
3483 rtx libname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3485 static CUMULATIVE_ARGS zero_cum;
3486 tree param, next_param;
3488 if (TARGET_DEBUG_E_MODE)
3490 fprintf (stderr,
3491 "\ninit_cumulative_args, fntype = 0x%.8lx", (long)fntype);
3493 if (!fntype)
3494 fputc ('\n', stderr);
3496 else
3498 tree ret_type = TREE_TYPE (fntype);
3499 fprintf (stderr, ", fntype code = %s, ret code = %s\n",
3500 tree_code_name[(int)TREE_CODE (fntype)],
3501 tree_code_name[(int)TREE_CODE (ret_type)]);
3505 *cum = zero_cum;
3506 cum->prototype = (fntype && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype));
3508 /* Determine if this function has variable arguments. This is
3509 indicated by the last argument being 'void_type_mode' if there
3510 are no variable arguments. The standard MIPS calling sequence
3511 passes all arguments in the general purpose registers in this case. */
3513 for (param = fntype ? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype) : 0;
3514 param != 0; param = next_param)
3516 next_param = TREE_CHAIN (param);
3517 if (next_param == 0 && TREE_VALUE (param) != void_type_node)
3518 cum->gp_reg_found = 1;
3523 /* Fill INFO with information about a single argument. CUM is the
3524 cumulative state for earlier arguments. MODE is the mode of this
3525 argument and TYPE is its type (if known). NAMED is true if this
3526 is a named (fixed) argument rather than a variable one. */
3528 static void
3529 mips_arg_info (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3530 tree type, int named, struct mips_arg_info *info)
3532 bool even_reg_p;
3533 unsigned int num_words, max_regs;
3535 /* Decide whether this argument should go in a floating-point register,
3536 assuming one is free. Later code checks for availability. */
3538 info->fpr_p = (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
3539 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
3541 if (info->fpr_p)
3542 switch (mips_abi)
3544 case ABI_32:
3545 case ABI_O64:
3546 info->fpr_p = (!cum->gp_reg_found
3547 && cum->arg_number < 2
3548 && (type == 0 || FLOAT_TYPE_P (type)));
3549 break;
3551 case ABI_N32:
3552 case ABI_64:
3553 info->fpr_p = (named && (type == 0 || FLOAT_TYPE_P (type)));
3554 break;
3557 /* Now decide whether the argument must go in an even-numbered register. */
3559 even_reg_p = false;
3560 if (info->fpr_p)
3562 /* Under the O64 ABI, the second float argument goes in $f13 if it
3563 is a double, but $f14 if it is a single. Otherwise, on a
3564 32-bit double-float machine, each FP argument must start in a
3565 new register pair. */
3566 even_reg_p = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE
3567 || (mips_abi == ABI_O64 && mode == SFmode)
3568 || FP_INC > 1);
3570 else if (!TARGET_64BIT || LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE == 128)
3572 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
3573 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
3574 even_reg_p = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD);
3576 else if (type != NULL_TREE && TYPE_ALIGN (type) > BITS_PER_WORD)
3577 even_reg_p = true;
3580 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI && MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type))
3581 /* This argument must be passed on the stack. Eat up all the
3582 remaining registers. */
3583 info->reg_offset = MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS;
3584 else
3586 /* Set REG_OFFSET to the register count we're interested in.
3587 The EABI allocates the floating-point registers separately,
3588 but the other ABIs allocate them like integer registers. */
3589 info->reg_offset = (mips_abi == ABI_EABI && info->fpr_p
3590 ? cum->num_fprs
3591 : cum->num_gprs);
3593 if (even_reg_p)
3594 info->reg_offset += info->reg_offset & 1;
3597 /* The alignment applied to registers is also applied to stack arguments. */
3598 info->stack_offset = cum->stack_words;
3599 if (even_reg_p)
3600 info->stack_offset += info->stack_offset & 1;
3602 if (mode == BLKmode)
3603 info->num_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
3604 else
3605 info->num_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3607 num_words = (info->num_bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3608 max_regs = MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - info->reg_offset;
3610 /* Partition the argument between registers and stack. */
3611 info->reg_words = MIN (num_words, max_regs);
3612 info->stack_words = num_words - info->reg_words;
3616 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE. */
3618 void
3619 function_arg_advance (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3620 tree type, int named)
3622 struct mips_arg_info info;
3624 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3626 if (!info.fpr_p)
3627 cum->gp_reg_found = true;
3629 /* See the comment above the cumulative args structure in mips.h
3630 for an explanation of what this code does. It assumes the O32
3631 ABI, which passes at most 2 arguments in float registers. */
3632 if (cum->arg_number < 2 && info.fpr_p)
3633 cum->fp_code += (mode == SFmode ? 1 : 2) << ((cum->arg_number - 1) * 2);
3635 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI || !info.fpr_p)
3636 cum->num_gprs = info.reg_offset + info.reg_words;
3637 else if (info.reg_words > 0)
3638 cum->num_fprs += FP_INC;
3640 if (info.stack_words > 0)
3641 cum->stack_words = info.stack_offset + info.stack_words;
3643 cum->arg_number++;
3646 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG. */
3648 struct rtx_def *
3649 function_arg (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3650 tree type, int named)
3652 struct mips_arg_info info;
3654 /* We will be called with a mode of VOIDmode after the last argument
3655 has been seen. Whatever we return will be passed to the call
3656 insn. If we need a mips16 fp_code, return a REG with the code
3657 stored as the mode. */
3658 if (mode == VOIDmode)
3660 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && cum->fp_code != 0)
3661 return gen_rtx_REG ((enum machine_mode) cum->fp_code, 0);
3663 else
3664 return 0;
3667 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3669 /* Return straight away if the whole argument is passed on the stack. */
3670 if (info.reg_offset == MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS)
3671 return 0;
3673 if (type != 0
3674 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
3675 && (mips_abi == ABI_N32 || mips_abi == ABI_64)
3676 && TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)
3677 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
3678 && named)
3680 /* The Irix 6 n32/n64 ABIs say that if any 64 bit chunk of the
3681 structure contains a double in its entirety, then that 64 bit
3682 chunk is passed in a floating point register. */
3683 tree field;
3685 /* First check to see if there is any such field. */
3686 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type); field; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
3687 if (TREE_CODE (field) == FIELD_DECL
3688 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == REAL_TYPE
3689 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (field)) == BITS_PER_WORD
3690 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0)
3691 && int_bit_position (field) % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
3692 break;
3694 if (field != 0)
3696 /* Now handle the special case by returning a PARALLEL
3697 indicating where each 64 bit chunk goes. INFO.REG_WORDS
3698 chunks are passed in registers. */
3699 unsigned int i;
3700 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
3701 rtx ret;
3703 /* assign_parms checks the mode of ENTRY_PARM, so we must
3704 use the actual mode here. */
3705 ret = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, rtvec_alloc (info.reg_words));
3707 bitpos = 0;
3708 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
3709 for (i = 0; i < info.reg_words; i++)
3711 rtx reg;
3713 for (; field; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
3714 if (TREE_CODE (field) == FIELD_DECL
3715 && int_bit_position (field) >= bitpos)
3716 break;
3718 if (field
3719 && int_bit_position (field) == bitpos
3720 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == REAL_TYPE
3721 && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
3722 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (field)) == BITS_PER_WORD)
3723 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, FP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset + i);
3724 else
3725 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, GP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset + i);
3727 XVECEXP (ret, 0, i)
3728 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, reg,
3729 GEN_INT (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3731 bitpos += BITS_PER_WORD;
3733 return ret;
3737 if (info.fpr_p)
3738 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset);
3739 else
3740 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, GP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset);
3744 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS. */
3747 function_arg_partial_nregs (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3748 enum machine_mode mode, tree type, int named)
3750 struct mips_arg_info info;
3752 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3753 return info.stack_words > 0 ? info.reg_words : 0;
3757 /* Return true if FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE) should return
3758 upward rather than downward. In other words, return true if the
3759 first byte of the stack slot has useful data, false if the last
3760 byte does. */
3762 bool
3763 mips_pad_arg_upward (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3765 /* On little-endian targets, the first byte of every stack argument
3766 is passed in the first byte of the stack slot. */
3767 if (!BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3768 return true;
3770 /* Otherwise, integral types are padded downward: the last byte of a
3771 stack argument is passed in the last byte of the stack slot. */
3772 if (type != 0
3773 ? INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) || POINTER_TYPE_P (type)
3774 : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
3775 return false;
3777 /* Big-endian o64 pads floating-point arguments downward. */
3778 if (mips_abi == ABI_O64)
3779 if (type != 0 ? FLOAT_TYPE_P (type) : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
3780 return false;
3782 /* Other types are padded upward for o32, o64, n32 and n64. */
3783 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI)
3784 return true;
3786 /* Arguments smaller than a stack slot are padded downward. */
3787 if (mode != BLKmode)
3788 return (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= PARM_BOUNDARY);
3789 else
3790 return (int_size_in_bytes (type) >= (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3794 /* Likewise BLOCK_REG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE, ...). Return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3795 if the least significant byte of the register has useful data. Return
3796 the opposite if the most significant byte does. */
3798 bool
3799 mips_pad_reg_upward (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3801 /* No shifting is required for floating-point arguments. */
3802 if (type != 0 ? FLOAT_TYPE_P (type) : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
3803 return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
3805 /* Otherwise, apply the same padding to register arguments as we do
3806 to stack arguments. */
3807 return mips_pad_arg_upward (mode, type);
3811 mips_setup_incoming_varargs (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3812 enum machine_mode mode, tree type, int no_rtl)
3814 CUMULATIVE_ARGS local_cum;
3815 int gp_saved, fp_saved;
3817 /* The caller has advanced CUM up to, but not beyond, the last named
3818 argument. Advance a local copy of CUM past the last "real" named
3819 argument, to find out how many registers are left over. */
3821 local_cum = *cum;
3822 FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (local_cum, mode, type, 1);
3824 /* Found out how many registers we need to save. */
3825 gp_saved = MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - local_cum.num_gprs;
3826 fp_saved = (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P
3827 ? MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - local_cum.num_fprs
3828 : 0);
3830 if (!no_rtl)
3832 if (gp_saved > 0)
3834 rtx ptr, mem;
3836 ptr = virtual_incoming_args_rtx;
3837 switch (mips_abi)
3839 case ABI_32:
3840 case ABI_O64:
3841 ptr = plus_constant (ptr, local_cum.num_gprs * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3842 break;
3844 case ABI_EABI:
3845 ptr = plus_constant (ptr, -gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3846 break;
3848 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, ptr);
3849 set_mem_alias_set (mem, get_varargs_alias_set ());
3851 move_block_from_reg (local_cum.num_gprs + GP_ARG_FIRST,
3852 mem, gp_saved);
3854 if (fp_saved > 0)
3856 /* We can't use move_block_from_reg, because it will use
3857 the wrong mode. */
3858 enum machine_mode mode;
3859 int off, i;
3861 /* Set OFF to the offset from virtual_incoming_args_rtx of
3862 the first float register. The FP save area lies below
3863 the integer one, and is aligned to UNITS_PER_FPVALUE bytes. */
3864 off = -gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3865 off &= ~(UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1);
3866 off -= fp_saved * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
3868 mode = TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT ? SFmode : DFmode;
3870 for (i = local_cum.num_fprs; i < MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS; i += FP_INC)
3872 rtx ptr, mem;
3874 ptr = plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, off);
3875 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, ptr);
3876 set_mem_alias_set (mem, get_varargs_alias_set ());
3877 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_ARG_FIRST + i));
3878 off += UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE;
3882 if (mips_abi == ABI_32 || mips_abi == ABI_O64)
3883 /* No need for pretend arguments: the register parameter area was
3884 allocated by the caller. */
3885 return 0;
3886 return (gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD) + (fp_saved * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
3889 /* Create the va_list data type.
3890 We keep 3 pointers, and two offsets.
3891 Two pointers are to the overflow area, which starts at the CFA.
3892 One of these is constant, for addressing into the GPR save area below it.
3893 The other is advanced up the stack through the overflow region.
3894 The third pointer is to the GPR save area. Since the FPR save area
3895 is just below it, we can address FPR slots off this pointer.
3896 We also keep two one-byte offsets, which are to be subtracted from the
3897 constant pointers to yield addresses in the GPR and FPR save areas.
3898 These are downcounted as float or non-float arguments are used,
3899 and when they get to zero, the argument must be obtained from the
3900 overflow region.
3901 If !EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P, then no FPR save area exists, and a single
3902 pointer is enough. It's started at the GPR save area, and is
3903 advanced, period.
3904 Note that the GPR save area is not constant size, due to optimization
3905 in the prologue. Hence, we can't use a design with two pointers
3906 and two offsets, although we could have designed this with two pointers
3907 and three offsets. */
3909 static tree
3910 mips_build_builtin_va_list (void)
3912 if (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
3914 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff, f_res, record;
3915 tree array, index;
3917 record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE);
3919 f_ovfl = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__overflow_argptr"),
3920 ptr_type_node);
3921 f_gtop = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__gpr_top"),
3922 ptr_type_node);
3923 f_ftop = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__fpr_top"),
3924 ptr_type_node);
3925 f_goff = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__gpr_offset"),
3926 unsigned_char_type_node);
3927 f_foff = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__fpr_offset"),
3928 unsigned_char_type_node);
3929 /* Explicitly pad to the size of a pointer, so that -Wpadded won't
3930 warn on every user file. */
3931 index = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_SIZE (ptr_mode) - 2 - 1, 0);
3932 array = build_array_type (unsigned_char_type_node,
3933 build_index_type (index));
3934 f_res = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__reserved"), array);
3936 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_ovfl) = record;
3937 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_gtop) = record;
3938 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_ftop) = record;
3939 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_goff) = record;
3940 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_foff) = record;
3941 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_res) = record;
3943 TYPE_FIELDS (record) = f_ovfl;
3944 TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl) = f_gtop;
3945 TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop) = f_ftop;
3946 TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop) = f_goff;
3947 TREE_CHAIN (f_goff) = f_foff;
3948 TREE_CHAIN (f_foff) = f_res;
3950 layout_type (record);
3951 return record;
3953 else if (TARGET_IRIX && !TARGET_IRIX5)
3954 /* On IRIX 6, this type is 'char *'. */
3955 return build_pointer_type (char_type_node);
3956 else
3957 /* Otherwise, we use 'void *'. */
3958 return ptr_type_node;
3961 /* Implement va_start. */
3963 void
3964 mips_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
3966 const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = &current_function_args_info;
3968 /* ARG_POINTER_REGNUM is initialized to STACK_POINTER_BOUNDARY, but
3969 since the stack is aligned for a pair of argument-passing slots,
3970 and the beginning of a variable argument list may be an odd slot,
3971 we have to decrease its alignment. */
3972 if (cfun && cfun->emit->regno_pointer_align)
3973 while (((current_function_pretend_args_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
3974 & (REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (ARG_POINTER_REGNUM) - 1)) != 0)
3975 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (ARG_POINTER_REGNUM) /= 2;
3977 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI)
3979 int gpr_save_area_size;
3981 gpr_save_area_size
3982 = (MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - cum->num_gprs) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3984 if (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
3986 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff;
3987 tree ovfl, gtop, ftop, goff, foff;
3988 tree t;
3989 int fpr_offset;
3990 int fpr_save_area_size;
3992 f_ovfl = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node);
3993 f_gtop = TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl);
3994 f_ftop = TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop);
3995 f_goff = TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop);
3996 f_foff = TREE_CHAIN (f_goff);
3998 ovfl = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ovfl), valist, f_ovfl);
3999 gtop = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_gtop), valist, f_gtop);
4000 ftop = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ftop), valist, f_ftop);
4001 goff = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_goff), valist, f_goff);
4002 foff = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_foff), valist, f_foff);
4004 /* Emit code to initialize OVFL, which points to the next varargs
4005 stack argument. CUM->STACK_WORDS gives the number of stack
4006 words used by named arguments. */
4007 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (ovfl), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
4008 if (cum->stack_words > 0)
4009 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), t,
4010 build_int_2 (cum->stack_words * UNITS_PER_WORD, 0));
4011 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, t);
4012 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4014 /* Emit code to initialize GTOP, the top of the GPR save area. */
4015 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (gtop), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
4016 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (gtop), gtop, t);
4017 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4019 /* Emit code to initialize FTOP, the top of the FPR save area.
4020 This address is gpr_save_area_bytes below GTOP, rounded
4021 down to the next fp-aligned boundary. */
4022 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (ftop), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
4023 fpr_offset = gpr_save_area_size + UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1;
4024 fpr_offset &= ~(UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1);
4025 if (fpr_offset)
4026 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ftop), t,
4027 build_int_2 (-fpr_offset, -1));
4028 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ftop), ftop, t);
4029 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4031 /* Emit code to initialize GOFF, the offset from GTOP of the
4032 next GPR argument. */
4033 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (goff), goff,
4034 build_int_2 (gpr_save_area_size, 0));
4035 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4037 /* Likewise emit code to initialize FOFF, the offset from FTOP
4038 of the next FPR argument. */
4039 fpr_save_area_size
4040 = (MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - cum->num_fprs) * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
4041 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (foff), foff,
4042 build_int_2 (fpr_save_area_size, 0));
4043 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4045 else
4047 /* Everything is in the GPR save area, or in the overflow
4048 area which is contiguous with it. */
4049 nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, -gpr_save_area_size);
4050 std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
4053 else
4054 std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
4057 /* Implement va_arg. */
4060 mips_va_arg (tree valist, tree type)
4062 HOST_WIDE_INT size, rsize;
4063 rtx addr_rtx;
4064 tree t;
4066 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
4067 rsize = (size + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) & -UNITS_PER_WORD;
4069 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI)
4071 bool indirect;
4072 rtx r;
4074 indirect
4075 = function_arg_pass_by_reference (NULL, TYPE_MODE (type), type, 0);
4077 if (indirect)
4079 size = POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4080 rsize = UNITS_PER_WORD;
4083 addr_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
4085 if (!EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
4087 /* Case of all args in a merged stack. No need to check bounds,
4088 just advance valist along the stack. */
4090 tree gpr = valist;
4091 if (!indirect
4092 && !TARGET_64BIT
4093 && TYPE_ALIGN (type) > (unsigned) BITS_PER_WORD)
4095 /* Align the pointer using: ap = (ap + align - 1) & -align,
4096 where align is 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD. */
4097 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (gpr), gpr,
4098 build_int_2 (2 * UNITS_PER_WORD - 1, 0));
4099 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t,
4100 build_int_2 (-2 * UNITS_PER_WORD, -1));
4101 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (gpr), gpr, t);
4102 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4105 /* Emit code to set addr_rtx to the valist, and postincrement
4106 the valist by the size of the argument, rounded up to the
4107 next word. */
4108 t = build (POSTINCREMENT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (gpr), gpr,
4109 size_int (rsize));
4110 r = expand_expr (t, addr_rtx, Pmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4111 if (r != addr_rtx)
4112 emit_move_insn (addr_rtx, r);
4114 /* Flush the POSTINCREMENT. */
4115 emit_queue();
4117 else
4119 /* Not a simple merged stack. */
4121 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff;
4122 tree ovfl, top, off;
4123 rtx lab_over = NULL_RTX, lab_false;
4124 HOST_WIDE_INT osize;
4126 f_ovfl = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node);
4127 f_gtop = TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl);
4128 f_ftop = TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop);
4129 f_goff = TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop);
4130 f_foff = TREE_CHAIN (f_goff);
4132 /* We maintain separate pointers and offsets for floating-point
4133 and integer arguments, but we need similar code in both cases.
4134 Let:
4136 TOP be the top of the register save area;
4137 OFF be the offset from TOP of the next register;
4138 ADDR_RTX be the address of the argument;
4139 RSIZE be the number of bytes used to store the argument
4140 when it's in the register save area;
4141 OSIZE be the number of bytes used to store it when it's
4142 in the stack overflow area; and
4143 PADDING be (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? OSIZE - RSIZE : 0)
4145 The code we want is:
4147 1: off &= -rsize; // round down
4148 2: if (off != 0)
4149 3: {
4150 4: addr_rtx = top - off;
4151 5: off -= rsize;
4152 6: }
4153 7: else
4154 8: {
4155 9: ovfl += ((intptr_t) ovfl + osize - 1) & -osize;
4156 10: addr_rtx = ovfl + PADDING;
4157 11: ovfl += osize;
4158 14: }
4160 [1] and [9] can sometimes be optimized away. */
4162 lab_false = gen_label_rtx ();
4163 lab_over = gen_label_rtx ();
4165 ovfl = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ovfl), valist, f_ovfl);
4166 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (type)) == MODE_FLOAT
4167 && GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
4169 top = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ftop), valist, f_ftop);
4170 off = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_foff), valist, f_foff);
4172 /* When floating-point registers are saved to the stack,
4173 each one will take up UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE bytes, regardless
4174 of the float's precision. */
4175 rsize = UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE;
4177 else
4179 top = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_gtop), valist, f_gtop);
4180 off = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_goff), valist, f_goff);
4181 if (rsize > UNITS_PER_WORD)
4183 /* [1] Emit code for: off &= -rsize. */
4184 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off,
4185 build_int_2 (-rsize, -1));
4186 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off, t);
4187 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4190 /* Every overflow argument must take up at least UNITS_PER_WORD
4191 bytes (= PARM_BOUNDARY bits). RSIZE can sometimes be smaller
4192 than that, such as in the combination -mgp64 -msingle-float
4193 -fshort-double. Doubles passed in registers will then take
4194 up UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE bytes, but those passed on the stack
4195 take up UNITS_PER_WORD bytes. */
4196 osize = MAX (rsize, UNITS_PER_WORD);
4198 /* [2] Emit code to branch if off == 0. */
4199 r = expand_expr (off, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (off)),
4200 EXPAND_NORMAL);
4201 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (r, const0_rtx, EQ, const1_rtx, GET_MODE (r),
4202 1, lab_false);
4204 /* [4] Emit code for: addr_rtx = top - off. */
4205 t = build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (top), top, off);
4206 r = expand_expr (t, addr_rtx, Pmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4207 if (r != addr_rtx)
4208 emit_move_insn (addr_rtx, r);
4210 /* [5] Emit code for: off -= rsize. */
4211 t = build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off, build_int_2 (rsize, 0));
4212 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off, t);
4213 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4215 /* [7] Emit code to jump over the else clause, then the label
4216 that starts it. */
4217 emit_queue();
4218 emit_jump (lab_over);
4219 emit_barrier ();
4220 emit_label (lab_false);
4222 if (osize > UNITS_PER_WORD)
4224 /* [9] Emit: ovfl += ((intptr_t) ovfl + osize - 1) & -osize. */
4225 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl,
4226 build_int_2 (osize - 1, 0));
4227 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), t,
4228 build_int_2 (-osize, -1));
4229 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, t);
4230 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4233 /* [10, 11]. Emit code to store ovfl in addr_rtx, then
4234 post-increment ovfl by osize. On big-endian machines,
4235 the argument has OSIZE - RSIZE bytes of leading padding. */
4236 t = build (POSTINCREMENT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl,
4237 size_int (osize));
4238 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && osize > rsize)
4239 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t,
4240 build_int_2 (osize - rsize, 0));
4241 r = expand_expr (t, addr_rtx, Pmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4242 if (r != addr_rtx)
4243 emit_move_insn (addr_rtx, r);
4245 emit_queue();
4246 emit_label (lab_over);
4248 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && rsize != size)
4249 addr_rtx = plus_constant (addr_rtx, rsize - size);
4250 if (indirect)
4252 addr_rtx = force_reg (Pmode, addr_rtx);
4253 r = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, addr_rtx);
4254 set_mem_alias_set (r, get_varargs_alias_set ());
4255 emit_move_insn (addr_rtx, r);
4257 return addr_rtx;
4259 else
4261 /* Not EABI. */
4262 int align;
4263 HOST_WIDE_INT min_offset;
4265 /* ??? The original va-mips.h did always align, despite the fact
4266 that alignments <= UNITS_PER_WORD are preserved by the va_arg
4267 increment mechanism. */
4269 if ((mips_abi == ABI_N32 || mips_abi == ABI_64)
4270 && TYPE_ALIGN (type) > 64)
4271 align = 16;
4272 else if (TARGET_64BIT)
4273 align = 8;
4274 else if (TYPE_ALIGN (type) > 32)
4275 align = 8;
4276 else
4277 align = 4;
4279 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
4280 build_int_2 (align - 1, 0));
4281 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t, build_int_2 (-align, -1));
4283 /* If arguments of type TYPE must be passed on the stack,
4284 set MIN_OFFSET to the offset of the first stack parameter. */
4285 if (!MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (TYPE_MODE (type), type))
4286 min_offset = 0;
4287 else if (TARGET_NEWABI)
4288 min_offset = current_function_pretend_args_size;
4289 else
4290 min_offset = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (current_function_decl);
4292 /* Make sure the new address is at least MIN_OFFSET bytes from
4293 the incoming argument pointer. */
4294 if (min_offset > 0)
4295 t = build (MAX_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), t,
4296 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (valist),
4297 plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
4298 min_offset)));
4300 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist, t);
4301 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4303 /* Everything past the alignment is standard. */
4304 return std_expand_builtin_va_arg (valist, type);
4308 /* Return true if it is possible to use left/right accesses for a
4309 bitfield of WIDTH bits starting BITPOS bits into *OP. When
4310 returning true, update *OP, *LEFT and *RIGHT as follows:
4312 *OP is a BLKmode reference to the whole field.
4314 *LEFT is a QImode reference to the first byte if big endian or
4315 the last byte if little endian. This address can be used in the
4316 left-side instructions (lwl, swl, ldl, sdl).
4318 *RIGHT is a QImode reference to the opposite end of the field and
4319 can be used in the parterning right-side instruction. */
4321 static bool
4322 mips_get_unaligned_mem (rtx *op, unsigned int width, int bitpos,
4323 rtx *left, rtx *right)
4325 rtx first, last;
4327 /* Check that the operand really is a MEM. Not all the extv and
4328 extzv predicates are checked. */
4329 if (GET_CODE (*op) != MEM)
4330 return false;
4332 /* Check that the size is valid. */
4333 if (width != 32 && (!TARGET_64BIT || width != 64))
4334 return false;
4336 /* We can only access byte-aligned values. Since we are always passed
4337 a reference to the first byte of the field, it is not necessary to
4338 do anything with BITPOS after this check. */
4339 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
4340 return false;
4342 /* Reject aligned bitfields: we want to use a normal load or store
4343 instead of a left/right pair. */
4344 if (MEM_ALIGN (*op) >= width)
4345 return false;
4347 /* Adjust *OP to refer to the whole field. This also has the effect
4348 of legitimizing *OP's address for BLKmode, possibly simplifying it. */
4349 *op = adjust_address (*op, BLKmode, 0);
4350 set_mem_size (*op, GEN_INT (width / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4352 /* Get references to both ends of the field. We deliberately don't
4353 use the original QImode *OP for FIRST since the new BLKmode one
4354 might have a simpler address. */
4355 first = adjust_address (*op, QImode, 0);
4356 last = adjust_address (*op, QImode, width / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
4358 /* Allocate to LEFT and RIGHT according to endiannes. LEFT should
4359 be the upper word and RIGHT the lower word. */
4360 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
4361 *left = first, *right = last;
4362 else
4363 *left = last, *right = first;
4365 return true;
4369 /* Try to emit the equivalent of (set DEST (zero_extract SRC WIDTH BITPOS)).
4370 Return true on success. We only handle cases where zero_extract is
4371 equivalent to sign_extract. */
4373 bool
4374 mips_expand_unaligned_load (rtx dest, rtx src, unsigned int width, int bitpos)
4376 rtx left, right;
4378 /* If TARGET_64BIT, the destination of a 32-bit load will be a
4379 paradoxical word_mode subreg. This is the only case in which
4380 we allow the destination to be larger than the source. */
4381 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
4382 && GET_MODE (dest) == DImode
4383 && SUBREG_BYTE (dest) == 0
4384 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest)) == SImode)
4385 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
4387 /* After the above adjustment, the destination must be the same
4388 width as the source. */
4389 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) != width)
4390 return false;
4392 if (!mips_get_unaligned_mem (&src, width, bitpos, &left, &right))
4393 return false;
4395 if (GET_MODE (dest) == DImode)
4397 emit_insn (gen_mov_ldl (dest, src, left));
4398 emit_insn (gen_mov_ldr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src),
4399 right, copy_rtx (dest)));
4401 else
4403 emit_insn (gen_mov_lwl (dest, src, left));
4404 emit_insn (gen_mov_lwr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src),
4405 right, copy_rtx (dest)));
4407 return true;
4411 /* Try to expand (set (zero_extract DEST WIDTH BITPOS) SRC). Return
4412 true on success. */
4414 bool
4415 mips_expand_unaligned_store (rtx dest, rtx src, unsigned int width, int bitpos)
4417 rtx left, right;
4419 if (!mips_get_unaligned_mem (&dest, width, bitpos, &left, &right))
4420 return false;
4422 src = gen_lowpart (mode_for_size (width, MODE_INT, 0), src);
4424 if (GET_MODE (src) == DImode)
4426 emit_insn (gen_mov_sdl (dest, src, left));
4427 emit_insn (gen_mov_sdr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src), right));
4429 else
4431 emit_insn (gen_mov_swl (dest, src, left));
4432 emit_insn (gen_mov_swr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src), right));
4434 return true;
4437 /* Set up globals to generate code for the ISA or processor
4438 described by INFO. */
4440 static void
4441 mips_set_architecture (const struct mips_cpu_info *info)
4443 if (info != 0)
4445 mips_arch_info = info;
4446 mips_arch = info->cpu;
4447 mips_isa = info->isa;
4452 /* Likewise for tuning. */
4454 static void
4455 mips_set_tune (const struct mips_cpu_info *info)
4457 if (info != 0)
4459 mips_tune_info = info;
4460 mips_tune = info->cpu;
4465 /* Set up the threshold for data to go into the small data area, instead
4466 of the normal data area, and detect any conflicts in the switches. */
4468 void
4469 override_options (void)
4471 int i, start, regno;
4472 enum machine_mode mode;
4474 mips_section_threshold = g_switch_set ? g_switch_value : MIPS_DEFAULT_GVALUE;
4476 /* Interpret -mabi. */
4477 mips_abi = MIPS_ABI_DEFAULT;
4478 if (mips_abi_string != 0)
4480 if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "32") == 0)
4481 mips_abi = ABI_32;
4482 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "o64") == 0)
4483 mips_abi = ABI_O64;
4484 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "n32") == 0)
4485 mips_abi = ABI_N32;
4486 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "64") == 0)
4487 mips_abi = ABI_64;
4488 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "eabi") == 0)
4489 mips_abi = ABI_EABI;
4490 else
4491 fatal_error ("bad value (%s) for -mabi= switch", mips_abi_string);
4494 /* The following code determines the architecture and register size.
4495 Similar code was added to GAS 2.14 (see tc-mips.c:md_after_parse_args()).
4496 The GAS and GCC code should be kept in sync as much as possible. */
4498 if (mips_arch_string != 0)
4499 mips_set_architecture (mips_parse_cpu ("-march", mips_arch_string));
4501 if (mips_isa_string != 0)
4503 /* Handle -mipsN. */
4504 char *whole_isa_str = concat ("mips", mips_isa_string, NULL);
4505 const struct mips_cpu_info *isa_info;
4507 isa_info = mips_parse_cpu ("-mips option", whole_isa_str);
4508 free (whole_isa_str);
4510 /* -march takes precedence over -mipsN, since it is more descriptive.
4511 There's no harm in specifying both as long as the ISA levels
4512 are the same. */
4513 if (mips_arch_info != 0 && mips_isa != isa_info->isa)
4514 error ("-mips%s conflicts with the other architecture options, "
4515 "which specify a MIPS%d processor",
4516 mips_isa_string, mips_isa);
4518 /* Set architecture based on the given option. */
4519 mips_set_architecture (isa_info);
4522 if (mips_arch_info == 0)
4524 #ifdef MIPS_CPU_STRING_DEFAULT
4525 mips_set_architecture (mips_parse_cpu ("default CPU",
4526 MIPS_CPU_STRING_DEFAULT));
4527 #else
4528 mips_set_architecture (mips_cpu_info_from_isa (MIPS_ISA_DEFAULT));
4529 #endif
4532 if (ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS && !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4533 error ("-march=%s is not compatible with the selected ABI",
4534 mips_arch_info->name);
4536 /* Optimize for mips_arch, unless -mtune selects a different processor. */
4537 if (mips_tune_string != 0)
4538 mips_set_tune (mips_parse_cpu ("-mtune", mips_tune_string));
4540 if (mips_tune_info == 0)
4541 mips_set_tune (mips_arch_info);
4543 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_64BIT) != 0)
4545 /* The user specified the size of the integer registers. Make sure
4546 it agrees with the ABI and ISA. */
4547 if (TARGET_64BIT && !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4548 error ("-mgp64 used with a 32-bit processor");
4549 else if (!TARGET_64BIT && ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS)
4550 error ("-mgp32 used with a 64-bit ABI");
4551 else if (TARGET_64BIT && ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS)
4552 error ("-mgp64 used with a 32-bit ABI");
4554 else
4556 /* Infer the integer register size from the ABI and processor.
4557 Restrict ourselves to 32-bit registers if that's all the
4558 processor has, or if the ABI cannot handle 64-bit registers. */
4559 if (ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS || !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4560 target_flags &= ~MASK_64BIT;
4561 else
4562 target_flags |= MASK_64BIT;
4565 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_FLOAT64) != 0)
4567 /* Really, -mfp32 and -mfp64 are ornamental options. There's
4568 only one right answer here. */
4569 if (TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT && !TARGET_FLOAT64)
4570 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mgp64 -mfp32 -mdouble-float");
4571 else if (!TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_FLOAT64)
4572 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mgp32 -mfp64");
4573 else if (TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT && TARGET_FLOAT64)
4574 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mfp64 -msingle-float");
4576 else
4578 /* -msingle-float selects 32-bit float registers. Otherwise the
4579 float registers should be the same size as the integer ones. */
4580 if (TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT)
4581 target_flags |= MASK_FLOAT64;
4582 else
4583 target_flags &= ~MASK_FLOAT64;
4586 /* End of code shared with GAS. */
4588 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LONG64) == 0)
4590 /* If no type size setting options (-mlong64,-mint64,-mlong32)
4591 were used, then set the type sizes. In the EABI in 64 bit mode,
4592 longs and pointers are 64 bits. Likewise for the SGI Irix6 N64
4593 ABI. */
4594 if ((mips_abi == ABI_EABI && TARGET_64BIT) || mips_abi == ABI_64)
4595 target_flags |= MASK_LONG64;
4596 else
4597 target_flags &= ~MASK_LONG64;
4600 if (MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT
4601 && (target_flags_explicit & MASK_SOFT_FLOAT) == 0)
4603 /* For some configurations, it is useful to have -march control
4604 the default setting of MASK_SOFT_FLOAT. */
4605 switch ((int) mips_arch)
4607 case PROCESSOR_R4100:
4608 case PROCESSOR_R4111:
4609 case PROCESSOR_R4120:
4610 target_flags |= MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4611 break;
4613 default:
4614 target_flags &= ~MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4615 break;
4619 if (mips_abi != ABI_32 && mips_abi != ABI_O64)
4620 flag_pcc_struct_return = 0;
4622 #if defined(USE_COLLECT2)
4623 /* For IRIX 5 or IRIX 6 with integrated O32 ABI support, USE_COLLECT2 is
4624 always defined when GNU as is not in use, but collect2 is only used
4625 for the O32 ABI, so override the toplev.c and target-def.h defaults
4626 for flag_gnu_linker, TARGET_ASM_{CONSTRUCTOR, DESTRUCTOR} and
4627 TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS.
4629 Since the IRIX 5 and IRIX 6 O32 assemblers cannot handle named
4630 sections, constructor/destructor handling depends on the ABI in use.
4632 Since USE_COLLECT2 is defined, we only need to restore the non-collect2
4633 defaults for the N32/N64 ABIs. */
4634 if (TARGET_IRIX && !TARGET_SGI_O32_AS)
4636 targetm.have_ctors_dtors = true;
4637 targetm.asm_out.constructor = default_named_section_asm_out_constructor;
4638 targetm.asm_out.destructor = default_named_section_asm_out_destructor;
4640 #endif
4642 /* Handle some quirks of the IRIX 5 and IRIX 6 O32 assemblers. */
4644 if (TARGET_SGI_O32_AS)
4646 /* They don't recognize `.[248]byte'. */
4647 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.hi = "\t.align 0\n\t.half\t";
4648 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = "\t.align 0\n\t.word\t";
4649 /* The IRIX 6 O32 assembler gives an error for `align 0; .dword',
4650 contrary to the documentation, so disable it. */
4651 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.di = NULL;
4653 /* They cannot handle named sections. */
4654 targetm.have_named_sections = false;
4655 /* Therefore, EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME isn't defined and we must use
4656 collect2. */
4657 targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info = true;
4658 targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section = collect2_eh_frame_section;
4660 /* They cannot handle debug information. */
4661 if (write_symbols != NO_DEBUG)
4663 /* Adapt wording to IRIX version: IRIX 5 only had a single ABI,
4664 so -mabi=32 isn't usually specified. */
4665 if (TARGET_IRIX5)
4666 inform ("-g is only supported using GNU as,");
4667 else
4668 inform ("-g is only supported using GNU as with -mabi=32,");
4669 inform ("-g option disabled");
4670 write_symbols = NO_DEBUG;
4674 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_BRANCHLIKELY) == 0)
4676 /* If neither -mbranch-likely nor -mno-branch-likely was given
4677 on the command line, set MASK_BRANCHLIKELY based on the target
4678 architecture.
4680 By default, we enable use of Branch Likely instructions on
4681 all architectures which support them except for MIPS32 and MIPS64
4682 (i.e., the generic MIPS32 and MIPS64 ISAs, and processors which
4683 implement them).
4685 The MIPS32 and MIPS64 architecture specifications say "Software
4686 is strongly encouraged to avoid use of Branch Likely
4687 instructions, as they will be removed from a future revision
4688 of the [MIPS32 and MIPS64] architecture." Therefore, we do not
4689 issue those instructions unless instructed to do so by
4690 -mbranch-likely. */
4691 if (ISA_HAS_BRANCHLIKELY && !(ISA_MIPS32 || ISA_MIPS32R2 || ISA_MIPS64))
4692 target_flags |= MASK_BRANCHLIKELY;
4693 else
4694 target_flags &= ~MASK_BRANCHLIKELY;
4696 if (TARGET_BRANCHLIKELY && !ISA_HAS_BRANCHLIKELY)
4697 warning ("generation of Branch Likely instructions enabled, but not supported by architecture");
4699 /* The effect of -mabicalls isn't defined for the EABI. */
4700 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI && TARGET_ABICALLS)
4702 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mabicalls -mabi=eabi");
4703 target_flags &= ~MASK_ABICALLS;
4706 /* -fpic (-KPIC) is the default when TARGET_ABICALLS is defined. We need
4707 to set flag_pic so that the LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P macro will work. */
4708 /* ??? -non_shared turns off pic code generation, but this is not
4709 implemented. */
4710 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
4712 flag_pic = 1;
4713 if (mips_section_threshold > 0)
4714 warning ("-G is incompatible with PIC code which is the default");
4717 /* The MIPS and SGI o32 assemblers expect small-data variables to
4718 be declared before they are used. Although we once had code to
4719 do this, it was very invasive and fragile. It no longer seems
4720 worth the effort. */
4721 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && !TARGET_GAS)
4722 mips_section_threshold = 0;
4724 /* We switch to small data sections using ".section", which the native
4725 o32 irix assemblers don't understand. Disable -G accordingly.
4726 We must do this regardless of command-line options since otherwise
4727 the compiler would abort. */
4728 if (!targetm.have_named_sections)
4729 mips_section_threshold = 0;
4731 /* -membedded-pic is a form of PIC code suitable for embedded
4732 systems. All calls are made using PC relative addressing, and
4733 all data is addressed using the $gp register. This requires gas,
4734 which does most of the work, and GNU ld, which automatically
4735 expands PC relative calls which are out of range into a longer
4736 instruction sequence. All gcc really does differently is
4737 generate a different sequence for a switch. */
4738 if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_PIC)
4740 flag_pic = 1;
4741 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
4742 warning ("-membedded-pic and -mabicalls are incompatible");
4744 if (g_switch_set)
4745 warning ("-G and -membedded-pic are incompatible");
4747 /* Setting mips_section_threshold is not required, because gas
4748 will force everything to be GP addressable anyhow, but
4749 setting it will cause gcc to make better estimates of the
4750 number of instructions required to access a particular data
4751 item. */
4752 mips_section_threshold = 0x7fffffff;
4755 /* mips_split_addresses is a half-way house between explicit
4756 relocations and the traditional assembler macros. It can
4757 split absolute 32-bit symbolic constants into a high/lo_sum
4758 pair but uses macros for other sorts of access.
4760 Like explicit relocation support for REL targets, it relies
4761 on GNU extensions in the assembler and the linker.
4763 Although this code should work for -O0, it has traditionally
4764 been treated as an optimization. */
4765 if (TARGET_GAS && !TARGET_MIPS16 && TARGET_SPLIT_ADDRESSES
4766 && optimize && !flag_pic
4767 && !ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS)
4768 mips_split_addresses = 1;
4769 else
4770 mips_split_addresses = 0;
4772 /* -mexplicit-relocs doesn't yet support non-PIC n64. We don't know
4773 how to generate %highest/%higher/%hi/%lo sequences. */
4774 if (mips_abi == ABI_64 && !TARGET_ABICALLS)
4776 if ((target_flags_explicit & target_flags & MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) != 0)
4777 sorry ("non-PIC n64 with explicit relocations");
4778 target_flags &= ~MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS;
4781 /* Explicit relocations for "old" ABIs are a GNU extension. Unless
4782 the user has said otherwise, assume that they are not available
4783 with assemblers other than gas. */
4784 if (!TARGET_NEWABI && !TARGET_GAS
4785 && (target_flags_explicit & MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) == 0)
4786 target_flags &= ~MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS;
4788 /* -mrnames says to use the MIPS software convention for register
4789 names instead of the hardware names (ie, $a0 instead of $4).
4790 We do this by switching the names in mips_reg_names, which the
4791 reg_names points into via the REGISTER_NAMES macro. */
4793 if (TARGET_NAME_REGS)
4794 memcpy (mips_reg_names, mips_sw_reg_names, sizeof (mips_reg_names));
4796 /* When compiling for the mips16, we can not use floating point. We
4797 record the original hard float value in mips16_hard_float. */
4798 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4800 if (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
4801 mips16_hard_float = 0;
4802 else
4803 mips16_hard_float = 1;
4804 target_flags |= MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4806 /* Don't run the scheduler before reload, since it tends to
4807 increase register pressure. */
4808 flag_schedule_insns = 0;
4810 /* Silently disable -mexplicit-relocs since it doesn't apply
4811 to mips16 code. Even so, it would overly pedantic to warn
4812 about "-mips16 -mexplicit-relocs", especially given that
4813 we use a %gprel() operator. */
4814 target_flags &= ~MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS;
4817 /* When using explicit relocs, we call dbr_schedule from within
4818 mips_reorg. */
4819 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
4821 mips_flag_delayed_branch = flag_delayed_branch;
4822 flag_delayed_branch = 0;
4825 #ifdef MIPS_TFMODE_FORMAT
4826 REAL_MODE_FORMAT (TFmode) = &MIPS_TFMODE_FORMAT;
4827 #endif
4829 mips_print_operand_punct['?'] = 1;
4830 mips_print_operand_punct['#'] = 1;
4831 mips_print_operand_punct['/'] = 1;
4832 mips_print_operand_punct['&'] = 1;
4833 mips_print_operand_punct['!'] = 1;
4834 mips_print_operand_punct['*'] = 1;
4835 mips_print_operand_punct['@'] = 1;
4836 mips_print_operand_punct['.'] = 1;
4837 mips_print_operand_punct['('] = 1;
4838 mips_print_operand_punct[')'] = 1;
4839 mips_print_operand_punct['['] = 1;
4840 mips_print_operand_punct[']'] = 1;
4841 mips_print_operand_punct['<'] = 1;
4842 mips_print_operand_punct['>'] = 1;
4843 mips_print_operand_punct['{'] = 1;
4844 mips_print_operand_punct['}'] = 1;
4845 mips_print_operand_punct['^'] = 1;
4846 mips_print_operand_punct['$'] = 1;
4847 mips_print_operand_punct['+'] = 1;
4848 mips_print_operand_punct['~'] = 1;
4850 mips_char_to_class['d'] = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REGS : GR_REGS;
4851 mips_char_to_class['e'] = M16_NA_REGS;
4852 mips_char_to_class['t'] = T_REG;
4853 mips_char_to_class['f'] = (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT ? FP_REGS : NO_REGS);
4854 mips_char_to_class['h'] = HI_REG;
4855 mips_char_to_class['l'] = LO_REG;
4856 mips_char_to_class['x'] = MD_REGS;
4857 mips_char_to_class['b'] = ALL_REGS;
4858 mips_char_to_class['c'] = (TARGET_ABICALLS ? PIC_FN_ADDR_REG :
4859 TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_NA_REGS :
4860 GR_REGS);
4861 mips_char_to_class['e'] = LEA_REGS;
4862 mips_char_to_class['j'] = PIC_FN_ADDR_REG;
4863 mips_char_to_class['y'] = GR_REGS;
4864 mips_char_to_class['z'] = ST_REGS;
4865 mips_char_to_class['B'] = COP0_REGS;
4866 mips_char_to_class['C'] = COP2_REGS;
4867 mips_char_to_class['D'] = COP3_REGS;
4869 /* Set up array to map GCC register number to debug register number.
4870 Ignore the special purpose register numbers. */
4872 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4873 mips_dbx_regno[i] = -1;
4875 start = GP_DBX_FIRST - GP_REG_FIRST;
4876 for (i = GP_REG_FIRST; i <= GP_REG_LAST; i++)
4877 mips_dbx_regno[i] = i + start;
4879 start = FP_DBX_FIRST - FP_REG_FIRST;
4880 for (i = FP_REG_FIRST; i <= FP_REG_LAST; i++)
4881 mips_dbx_regno[i] = i + start;
4883 mips_dbx_regno[HI_REGNUM] = MD_DBX_FIRST + 0;
4884 mips_dbx_regno[LO_REGNUM] = MD_DBX_FIRST + 1;
4886 /* Set up array giving whether a given register can hold a given mode. */
4888 for (mode = VOIDmode;
4889 mode != MAX_MACHINE_MODE;
4890 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int)mode + 1))
4892 register int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4893 register enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
4895 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
4897 register int temp;
4899 if (mode == CCmode)
4901 if (! ISA_HAS_8CC)
4902 temp = (regno == FPSW_REGNUM);
4903 else
4904 temp = (ST_REG_P (regno) || GP_REG_P (regno)
4905 || FP_REG_P (regno));
4908 else if (GP_REG_P (regno))
4909 temp = ((regno & 1) == 0 || size <= UNITS_PER_WORD);
4911 else if (FP_REG_P (regno))
4912 temp = ((regno % FP_INC) == 0)
4913 && (((class == MODE_FLOAT || class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
4914 && size <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
4915 /* Allow integer modes that fit into a single
4916 register. We need to put integers into FPRs
4917 when using instructions like cvt and trunc. */
4918 || (class == MODE_INT && size <= UNITS_PER_FPREG)
4919 /* Allow TFmode for CCmode reloads. */
4920 || (ISA_HAS_8CC && mode == TFmode));
4922 else if (MD_REG_P (regno))
4923 temp = (class == MODE_INT
4924 && (size <= UNITS_PER_WORD
4925 || (regno == MD_REG_FIRST
4926 && size == 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)));
4928 else if (ALL_COP_REG_P (regno))
4929 temp = (class == MODE_INT && size <= UNITS_PER_WORD);
4930 else
4931 temp = 0;
4933 mips_hard_regno_mode_ok[(int)mode][regno] = temp;
4937 /* Save GPR registers in word_mode sized hunks. word_mode hasn't been
4938 initialized yet, so we can't use that here. */
4939 gpr_mode = TARGET_64BIT ? DImode : SImode;
4941 /* Provide default values for align_* for 64-bit targets. */
4942 if (TARGET_64BIT && !TARGET_MIPS16)
4944 if (align_loops == 0)
4945 align_loops = 8;
4946 if (align_jumps == 0)
4947 align_jumps = 8;
4948 if (align_functions == 0)
4949 align_functions = 8;
4952 /* Function to allocate machine-dependent function status. */
4953 init_machine_status = &mips_init_machine_status;
4955 /* Create a unique alias set for GOT references. */
4956 mips_got_alias_set = new_alias_set ();
4958 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS || mips_split_addresses)
4960 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = true;
4961 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = "%hi(";
4962 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = "%lo(";
4965 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4967 /* The high part is provided by a pseudo copy of $gp. */
4968 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = true;
4969 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = "%gprel(";
4972 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
4974 /* Small data constants are kept whole until after reload,
4975 then lowered by mips_rewrite_small_data. */
4976 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = "%gp_rel(";
4978 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = true;
4979 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
4981 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE] = "%got_page(";
4982 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = "%got_ofst(";
4984 else
4986 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE] = "%got(";
4987 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = "%lo(";
4990 if (TARGET_XGOT)
4992 /* The HIGH and LO_SUM are matched by special .md patterns. */
4993 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL] = true;
4995 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = true;
4996 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_hi(";
4997 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_lo(";
4999 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = true;
5000 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call_hi(";
5001 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call_lo(";
5003 else
5005 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
5006 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_disp(";
5007 else
5008 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got(";
5009 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call16(";
5013 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
5015 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = true;
5016 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = "%hi(%neg(%gp_rel(";
5017 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = "%lo(%neg(%gp_rel(";
5021 /* Implement CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE. */
5023 void
5024 mips_conditional_register_usage (void)
5026 if (!TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
5028 int regno;
5030 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST; regno <= FP_REG_LAST; regno++)
5031 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
5032 for (regno = ST_REG_FIRST; regno <= ST_REG_LAST; regno++)
5033 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
5035 else if (! ISA_HAS_8CC)
5037 int regno;
5039 /* We only have a single condition code register. We
5040 implement this by hiding all the condition code registers,
5041 and generating RTL that refers directly to ST_REG_FIRST. */
5042 for (regno = ST_REG_FIRST; regno <= ST_REG_LAST; regno++)
5043 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
5045 /* In mips16 mode, we permit the $t temporary registers to be used
5046 for reload. We prohibit the unused $s registers, since they
5047 are caller saved, and saving them via a mips16 register would
5048 probably waste more time than just reloading the value. */
5049 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
5051 fixed_regs[18] = call_used_regs[18] = 1;
5052 fixed_regs[19] = call_used_regs[19] = 1;
5053 fixed_regs[20] = call_used_regs[20] = 1;
5054 fixed_regs[21] = call_used_regs[21] = 1;
5055 fixed_regs[22] = call_used_regs[22] = 1;
5056 fixed_regs[23] = call_used_regs[23] = 1;
5057 fixed_regs[26] = call_used_regs[26] = 1;
5058 fixed_regs[27] = call_used_regs[27] = 1;
5059 fixed_regs[30] = call_used_regs[30] = 1;
5061 /* fp20-23 are now caller saved. */
5062 if (mips_abi == ABI_64)
5064 int regno;
5065 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST + 20; regno < FP_REG_FIRST + 24; regno++)
5066 call_really_used_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
5068 /* odd registers from fp21 to fp31 are now caller saved. */
5069 if (mips_abi == ABI_N32)
5071 int regno;
5072 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST + 21; regno <= FP_REG_FIRST + 31; regno+=2)
5073 call_really_used_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
5077 /* Allocate a chunk of memory for per-function machine-dependent data. */
5078 static struct machine_function *
5079 mips_init_machine_status (void)
5081 return ((struct machine_function *)
5082 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct machine_function)));
5085 /* On the mips16, we want to allocate $24 (T_REG) before other
5086 registers for instructions for which it is possible. This helps
5087 avoid shuffling registers around in order to set up for an xor,
5088 encouraging the compiler to use a cmp instead. */
5090 void
5091 mips_order_regs_for_local_alloc (void)
5093 register int i;
5095 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
5096 reg_alloc_order[i] = i;
5098 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
5100 /* It really doesn't matter where we put register 0, since it is
5101 a fixed register anyhow. */
5102 reg_alloc_order[0] = 24;
5103 reg_alloc_order[24] = 0;
5108 /* The MIPS debug format wants all automatic variables and arguments
5109 to be in terms of the virtual frame pointer (stack pointer before
5110 any adjustment in the function), while the MIPS 3.0 linker wants
5111 the frame pointer to be the stack pointer after the initial
5112 adjustment. So, we do the adjustment here. The arg pointer (which
5113 is eliminated) points to the virtual frame pointer, while the frame
5114 pointer (which may be eliminated) points to the stack pointer after
5115 the initial adjustments. */
5117 HOST_WIDE_INT
5118 mips_debugger_offset (rtx addr, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5120 rtx offset2 = const0_rtx;
5121 rtx reg = eliminate_constant_term (addr, &offset2);
5123 if (offset == 0)
5124 offset = INTVAL (offset2);
5126 if (reg == stack_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx
5127 || reg == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
5129 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size = (!cfun->machine->frame.initialized)
5130 ? compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ())
5131 : cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
5133 /* MIPS16 frame is smaller */
5134 if (frame_pointer_needed && TARGET_MIPS16)
5135 frame_size -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
5137 offset = offset - frame_size;
5140 /* sdbout_parms does not want this to crash for unrecognized cases. */
5141 #if 0
5142 else if (reg != arg_pointer_rtx)
5143 fatal_insn ("mips_debugger_offset called with non stack/frame/arg pointer",
5144 addr);
5145 #endif
5147 return offset;
5150 /* Implement the PRINT_OPERAND macro. The MIPS-specific operand codes are:
5152 'X' OP is CONST_INT, prints 32 bits in hexadecimal format = "0x%08x",
5153 'x' OP is CONST_INT, prints 16 bits in hexadecimal format = "0x%04x",
5154 'h' OP is HIGH, prints %hi(X),
5155 'd' output integer constant in decimal,
5156 'z' if the operand is 0, use $0 instead of normal operand.
5157 'D' print second part of double-word register or memory operand.
5158 'L' print low-order register of double-word register operand.
5159 'M' print high-order register of double-word register operand.
5160 'C' print part of opcode for a branch condition.
5161 'F' print part of opcode for a floating-point branch condition.
5162 'N' print part of opcode for a branch condition, inverted.
5163 'W' print part of opcode for a floating-point branch condition, inverted.
5164 'S' OP is CODE_LABEL, print with prefix of "LS" (for embedded switch).
5165 'B' print 'z' for EQ, 'n' for NE
5166 'b' print 'n' for EQ, 'z' for NE
5167 'T' print 'f' for EQ, 't' for NE
5168 't' print 't' for EQ, 'f' for NE
5169 'Z' print register and a comma, but print nothing for $fcc0
5170 'R' print the reloc associated with LO_SUM
5172 The punctuation characters are:
5174 '(' Turn on .set noreorder
5175 ')' Turn on .set reorder
5176 '[' Turn on .set noat
5177 ']' Turn on .set at
5178 '<' Turn on .set nomacro
5179 '>' Turn on .set macro
5180 '{' Turn on .set volatile (not GAS)
5181 '}' Turn on .set novolatile (not GAS)
5182 '&' Turn on .set noreorder if filling delay slots
5183 '*' Turn on both .set noreorder and .set nomacro if filling delay slots
5184 '!' Turn on .set nomacro if filling delay slots
5185 '#' Print nop if in a .set noreorder section.
5186 '/' Like '#', but does nothing within a delayed branch sequence
5187 '?' Print 'l' if we are to use a branch likely instead of normal branch.
5188 '@' Print the name of the assembler temporary register (at or $1).
5189 '.' Print the name of the register with a hard-wired zero (zero or $0).
5190 '^' Print the name of the pic call-through register (t9 or $25).
5191 '$' Print the name of the stack pointer register (sp or $29).
5192 '+' Print the name of the gp register (usually gp or $28).
5193 '~' Output a branch alignment to LABEL_ALIGN(NULL). */
5195 void
5196 print_operand (FILE *file, rtx op, int letter)
5198 register enum rtx_code code;
5200 if (PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (letter))
5202 switch (letter)
5204 case '?':
5205 if (mips_branch_likely)
5206 putc ('l', file);
5207 break;
5209 case '@':
5210 fputs (reg_names [GP_REG_FIRST + 1], file);
5211 break;
5213 case '^':
5214 fputs (reg_names [PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM], file);
5215 break;
5217 case '.':
5218 fputs (reg_names [GP_REG_FIRST + 0], file);
5219 break;
5221 case '$':
5222 fputs (reg_names[STACK_POINTER_REGNUM], file);
5223 break;
5225 case '+':
5226 fputs (reg_names[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM], file);
5227 break;
5229 case '&':
5230 if (final_sequence != 0 && set_noreorder++ == 0)
5231 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
5232 break;
5234 case '*':
5235 if (final_sequence != 0)
5237 if (set_noreorder++ == 0)
5238 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
5240 if (set_nomacro++ == 0)
5241 fputs (".set\tnomacro\n\t", file);
5243 break;
5245 case '!':
5246 if (final_sequence != 0 && set_nomacro++ == 0)
5247 fputs ("\n\t.set\tnomacro", file);
5248 break;
5250 case '#':
5251 if (set_noreorder != 0)
5252 fputs ("\n\tnop", file);
5253 break;
5255 case '/':
5256 /* Print an extra newline so that the delayed insn is separated
5257 from the following ones. This looks neater and is consistent
5258 with non-nop delayed sequences. */
5259 if (set_noreorder != 0 && final_sequence == 0)
5260 fputs ("\n\tnop\n", file);
5261 break;
5263 case '(':
5264 if (set_noreorder++ == 0)
5265 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
5266 break;
5268 case ')':
5269 if (set_noreorder == 0)
5270 error ("internal error: %%) found without a %%( in assembler pattern");
5272 else if (--set_noreorder == 0)
5273 fputs ("\n\t.set\treorder", file);
5275 break;
5277 case '[':
5278 if (set_noat++ == 0)
5279 fputs (".set\tnoat\n\t", file);
5280 break;
5282 case ']':
5283 if (set_noat == 0)
5284 error ("internal error: %%] found without a %%[ in assembler pattern");
5285 else if (--set_noat == 0)
5286 fputs ("\n\t.set\tat", file);
5288 break;
5290 case '<':
5291 if (set_nomacro++ == 0)
5292 fputs (".set\tnomacro\n\t", file);
5293 break;
5295 case '>':
5296 if (set_nomacro == 0)
5297 error ("internal error: %%> found without a %%< in assembler pattern");
5298 else if (--set_nomacro == 0)
5299 fputs ("\n\t.set\tmacro", file);
5301 break;
5303 case '{':
5304 if (set_volatile++ == 0)
5305 fprintf (file, "%s.set\tvolatile\n\t", TARGET_MIPS_AS ? "" : "#");
5306 break;
5308 case '}':
5309 if (set_volatile == 0)
5310 error ("internal error: %%} found without a %%{ in assembler pattern");
5311 else if (--set_volatile == 0)
5312 fprintf (file, "\n\t%s.set\tnovolatile", (TARGET_MIPS_AS) ? "" : "#");
5314 break;
5316 case '~':
5318 if (align_labels_log > 0)
5319 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (file, align_labels_log);
5321 break;
5323 default:
5324 error ("PRINT_OPERAND: unknown punctuation '%c'", letter);
5325 break;
5328 return;
5331 if (! op)
5333 error ("PRINT_OPERAND null pointer");
5334 return;
5337 code = GET_CODE (op);
5339 if (letter == 'C')
5340 switch (code)
5342 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
5343 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
5344 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
5345 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
5346 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
5347 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
5348 case GTU: fputs ("gtu", file); break;
5349 case GEU: fputs ("geu", file); break;
5350 case LTU: fputs ("ltu", file); break;
5351 case LEU: fputs ("leu", file); break;
5352 default:
5353 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%C", op);
5356 else if (letter == 'N')
5357 switch (code)
5359 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
5360 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
5361 case GT: fputs ("le", file); break;
5362 case GE: fputs ("lt", file); break;
5363 case LT: fputs ("ge", file); break;
5364 case LE: fputs ("gt", file); break;
5365 case GTU: fputs ("leu", file); break;
5366 case GEU: fputs ("ltu", file); break;
5367 case LTU: fputs ("geu", file); break;
5368 case LEU: fputs ("gtu", file); break;
5369 default:
5370 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%N", op);
5373 else if (letter == 'F')
5374 switch (code)
5376 case EQ: fputs ("c1f", file); break;
5377 case NE: fputs ("c1t", file); break;
5378 default:
5379 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%F", op);
5382 else if (letter == 'W')
5383 switch (code)
5385 case EQ: fputs ("c1t", file); break;
5386 case NE: fputs ("c1f", file); break;
5387 default:
5388 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%W", op);
5391 else if (letter == 'h')
5393 if (GET_CODE (op) == HIGH)
5394 op = XEXP (op, 0);
5396 print_operand_reloc (file, op, mips_hi_relocs);
5399 else if (letter == 'R')
5400 print_operand_reloc (file, op, mips_lo_relocs);
5402 else if (letter == 'S')
5404 char buffer[100];
5406 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buffer, "LS", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (op));
5407 assemble_name (file, buffer);
5410 else if (letter == 'Z')
5412 register int regnum;
5414 if (code != REG)
5415 abort ();
5417 regnum = REGNO (op);
5418 if (! ST_REG_P (regnum))
5419 abort ();
5421 if (regnum != ST_REG_FIRST)
5422 fprintf (file, "%s,", reg_names[regnum]);
5425 else if (code == REG || code == SUBREG)
5427 register int regnum;
5429 if (code == REG)
5430 regnum = REGNO (op);
5431 else
5432 regnum = true_regnum (op);
5434 if ((letter == 'M' && ! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5435 || (letter == 'L' && WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5436 || letter == 'D')
5437 regnum++;
5439 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[regnum]);
5442 else if (code == MEM)
5444 if (letter == 'D')
5445 output_address (plus_constant (XEXP (op, 0), 4));
5446 else
5447 output_address (XEXP (op, 0));
5450 else if (letter == 'x' && GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
5451 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, 0xffff & INTVAL(op));
5453 else if (letter == 'X' && GET_CODE(op) == CONST_INT)
5454 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, INTVAL (op));
5456 else if (letter == 'd' && GET_CODE(op) == CONST_INT)
5457 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (INTVAL(op)));
5459 else if (letter == 'z' && op == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (op)))
5460 fputs (reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST], file);
5462 else if (letter == 'd' || letter == 'x' || letter == 'X')
5463 output_operand_lossage ("invalid use of %%d, %%x, or %%X");
5465 else if (letter == 'B')
5466 fputs (code == EQ ? "z" : "n", file);
5467 else if (letter == 'b')
5468 fputs (code == EQ ? "n" : "z", file);
5469 else if (letter == 'T')
5470 fputs (code == EQ ? "f" : "t", file);
5471 else if (letter == 't')
5472 fputs (code == EQ ? "t" : "f", file);
5474 else if (CONST_GP_P (op))
5475 print_operand (file, XEXP (op, 0), letter);
5477 else
5478 output_addr_const (file, op);
5482 /* Print symbolic operand OP, which is part of a HIGH or LO_SUM.
5483 RELOCS is the array of relocations to use. */
5485 static void
5486 print_operand_reloc (FILE *file, rtx op, const char **relocs)
5488 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
5489 const char *p;
5490 rtx base;
5491 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
5493 if (!mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type) || relocs[symbol_type] == 0)
5494 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid operand for relocation", op);
5496 /* If OP uses an UNSPEC address, we want to print the inner symbol. */
5497 mips_split_const (op, &base, &offset);
5498 if (UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P (base))
5499 op = plus_constant (UNSPEC_ADDRESS (base), offset);
5501 fputs (relocs[symbol_type], file);
5502 output_addr_const (file, op);
5503 for (p = relocs[symbol_type]; *p != 0; p++)
5504 if (*p == '(')
5505 fputc (')', file);
5508 /* Output address operand X to FILE. */
5510 void
5511 print_operand_address (FILE *file, rtx x)
5513 struct mips_address_info addr;
5515 if (mips_classify_address (&addr, x, word_mode, true))
5516 switch (addr.type)
5518 case ADDRESS_REG:
5519 print_operand (file, addr.offset, 0);
5520 fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names[REGNO (addr.reg)]);
5521 return;
5523 case ADDRESS_LO_SUM:
5524 print_operand (file, addr.offset, 'R');
5525 fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names[REGNO (addr.reg)]);
5526 return;
5528 case ADDRESS_CONST_INT:
5529 case ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
5530 output_addr_const (file, x);
5531 return;
5533 abort ();
5536 /* Target hook for assembling integer objects. It appears that the Irix
5537 6 assembler can't handle 64-bit decimal integers, so avoid printing
5538 such an integer here. */
5540 static bool
5541 mips_assemble_integer (rtx x, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
5543 if ((TARGET_64BIT || TARGET_GAS) && size == 8 && aligned_p)
5545 fputs ("\t.dword\t", asm_out_file);
5546 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64 || GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
5547 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, x);
5548 else
5549 print_operand (asm_out_file, x, 'X');
5550 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5551 return true;
5553 return default_assemble_integer (x, size, aligned_p);
5556 /* When using assembler macros, keep track of all of small-data externs
5557 so that mips_file_end can emit the appropriate declarations for them.
5559 In most cases it would be safe (though pointless) to emit .externs
5560 for other symbols too. One exception is when an object is within
5561 the -G limit but declared by the user to be in a section other
5562 than .sbss or .sdata. */
5565 mips_output_external (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, tree decl, const char *name)
5567 register struct extern_list *p;
5569 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && mips_in_small_data_p (decl))
5571 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5572 p->next = extern_head;
5573 p->name = name;
5574 p->size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5575 extern_head = p;
5578 if (TARGET_IRIX && mips_abi == ABI_32 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
5580 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5581 p->next = extern_head;
5582 p->name = name;
5583 p->size = -1;
5584 extern_head = p;
5587 return 0;
5590 #if TARGET_IRIX
5591 void
5592 irix_output_external_libcall (rtx fun)
5594 register struct extern_list *p;
5596 if (mips_abi == ABI_32)
5598 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5599 p->next = extern_head;
5600 p->name = XSTR (fun, 0);
5601 p->size = -1;
5602 extern_head = p;
5605 #endif
5607 /* Emit a new filename to a stream. If we are smuggling stabs, try to
5608 put out a MIPS ECOFF file and a stab. */
5610 void
5611 mips_output_filename (FILE *stream, const char *name)
5613 char ltext_label_name[100];
5615 /* If we are emitting DWARF-2, let dwarf2out handle the ".file"
5616 directives. */
5617 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG)
5618 return;
5619 else if (mips_output_filename_first_time)
5621 mips_output_filename_first_time = 0;
5622 SET_FILE_NUMBER ();
5623 current_function_file = name;
5624 ASM_OUTPUT_FILENAME (stream, num_source_filenames, name);
5625 /* This tells mips-tfile that stabs will follow. */
5626 if (!TARGET_GAS && write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
5627 fprintf (stream, "\t#@stabs\n");
5630 else if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
5632 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ltext_label_name, "Ltext", 0);
5633 fprintf (stream, "%s", ASM_STABS_OP);
5634 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
5635 fprintf (stream, ",%d,0,0,%s\n", N_SOL, &ltext_label_name[1]);
5638 else if (name != current_function_file
5639 && strcmp (name, current_function_file) != 0)
5641 SET_FILE_NUMBER ();
5642 current_function_file = name;
5643 ASM_OUTPUT_FILENAME (stream, num_source_filenames, name);
5647 /* Emit a linenumber. For encapsulated stabs, we need to put out a stab
5648 as well as a .loc, since it is possible that MIPS ECOFF might not be
5649 able to represent the location for inlines that come from a different
5650 file. */
5652 void
5653 mips_output_lineno (FILE *stream, int line)
5655 if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
5657 ++sym_lineno;
5658 fprintf (stream, "%sLM%d:\n%s%d,0,%d,%sLM%d\n",
5659 LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX, sym_lineno, ASM_STABN_OP, N_SLINE, line,
5660 LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX, sym_lineno);
5662 else
5664 fprintf (stream, "\n\t.loc\t%d %d\n", num_source_filenames, line);
5665 LABEL_AFTER_LOC (stream);
5669 /* Output an ASCII string, in a space-saving way. */
5671 void
5672 mips_output_ascii (FILE *stream, const char *string_param, size_t len)
5674 size_t i;
5675 int cur_pos = 17;
5676 register const unsigned char *string =
5677 (const unsigned char *)string_param;
5679 fprintf (stream, "\t.ascii\t\"");
5680 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
5682 register int c = string[i];
5684 switch (c)
5686 case '\"':
5687 case '\\':
5688 putc ('\\', stream);
5689 putc (c, stream);
5690 cur_pos += 2;
5691 break;
5693 case TARGET_NEWLINE:
5694 fputs ("\\n", stream);
5695 if (i+1 < len
5696 && (((c = string[i+1]) >= '\040' && c <= '~')
5697 || c == TARGET_TAB))
5698 cur_pos = 32767; /* break right here */
5699 else
5700 cur_pos += 2;
5701 break;
5703 case TARGET_TAB:
5704 fputs ("\\t", stream);
5705 cur_pos += 2;
5706 break;
5708 case TARGET_FF:
5709 fputs ("\\f", stream);
5710 cur_pos += 2;
5711 break;
5713 case TARGET_BS:
5714 fputs ("\\b", stream);
5715 cur_pos += 2;
5716 break;
5718 case TARGET_CR:
5719 fputs ("\\r", stream);
5720 cur_pos += 2;
5721 break;
5723 default:
5724 if (c >= ' ' && c < 0177)
5726 putc (c, stream);
5727 cur_pos++;
5729 else
5731 fprintf (stream, "\\%03o", c);
5732 cur_pos += 4;
5736 if (cur_pos > 72 && i+1 < len)
5738 cur_pos = 17;
5739 fprintf (stream, "\"\n\t.ascii\t\"");
5742 fprintf (stream, "\"\n");
5745 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_FILE_START. */
5747 static void
5748 mips_file_start (void)
5750 default_file_start ();
5752 /* Versions of the MIPS assembler before 2.20 generate errors if a branch
5753 inside of a .set noreorder section jumps to a label outside of the .set
5754 noreorder section. Revision 2.20 just set nobopt silently rather than
5755 fixing the bug. */
5757 if (TARGET_MIPS_AS && optimize && flag_delayed_branch)
5758 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnobopt\n");
5760 if (TARGET_GAS)
5762 #if defined(OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF) && !TARGET_IRIX
5763 /* Generate a special section to describe the ABI switches used to
5764 produce the resultant binary. This used to be done by the assembler
5765 setting bits in the ELF header's flags field, but we have run out of
5766 bits. GDB needs this information in order to be able to correctly
5767 debug these binaries. See the function mips_gdbarch_init() in
5768 gdb/mips-tdep.c. This is unnecessary for the IRIX 5/6 ABIs and
5769 causes unnecessary IRIX 6 ld warnings. */
5770 const char * abi_string = NULL;
5772 switch (mips_abi)
5774 case ABI_32: abi_string = "abi32"; break;
5775 case ABI_N32: abi_string = "abiN32"; break;
5776 case ABI_64: abi_string = "abi64"; break;
5777 case ABI_O64: abi_string = "abiO64"; break;
5778 case ABI_EABI: abi_string = TARGET_64BIT ? "eabi64" : "eabi32"; break;
5779 default:
5780 abort ();
5782 /* Note - we use fprintf directly rather than called named_section()
5783 because in this way we can avoid creating an allocated section. We
5784 do not want this section to take up any space in the running
5785 executable. */
5786 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.section .mdebug.%s\n", abi_string);
5788 /* Restore the default section. */
5789 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
5790 #endif
5793 /* Generate the pseudo ops that System V.4 wants. */
5794 #ifndef ABICALLS_ASM_OP
5795 #define ABICALLS_ASM_OP "\t.abicalls"
5796 #endif
5797 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
5798 /* ??? but do not want this (or want pic0) if -non-shared? */
5799 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", ABICALLS_ASM_OP);
5801 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
5802 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
5804 if (flag_verbose_asm)
5805 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\n%s -G value = %d, Arch = %s, ISA = %d\n",
5806 ASM_COMMENT_START,
5807 mips_section_threshold, mips_arch_info->name, mips_isa);
5810 #ifdef BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5811 /* Implement ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS. This differs from the default only
5812 in the use of sbss. */
5814 void
5815 mips_output_aligned_bss (FILE *stream, tree decl, const char *name,
5816 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align)
5818 extern tree last_assemble_variable_decl;
5820 if (mips_in_small_data_p (decl))
5821 named_section (0, ".sbss", 0);
5822 else
5823 bss_section ();
5824 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (stream, floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
5825 last_assemble_variable_decl = decl;
5826 ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (stream, name, decl);
5827 ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (stream, size != 0 ? size : 1);
5829 #endif
5831 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_FILE_END. When using assembler macros, emit
5832 .externs for any small-data variables that turned out to be external. */
5834 static void
5835 mips_file_end (void)
5837 tree name_tree;
5838 struct extern_list *p;
5840 if (extern_head)
5842 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
5844 for (p = extern_head; p != 0; p = p->next)
5846 name_tree = get_identifier (p->name);
5848 /* Positively ensure only one .extern for any given symbol. */
5849 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree)
5850 && TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (name_tree))
5852 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
5853 /* In IRIX 5 or IRIX 6 for the O32 ABI, we must output a
5854 `.global name .text' directive for every used but
5855 undefined function. If we don't, the linker may perform
5856 an optimization (skipping over the insns that set $gp)
5857 when it is unsafe. */
5858 if (TARGET_IRIX && mips_abi == ABI_32 && p->size == -1)
5860 fputs ("\t.globl ", asm_out_file);
5861 assemble_name (asm_out_file, p->name);
5862 fputs (" .text\n", asm_out_file);
5864 else
5866 fputs ("\t.extern\t", asm_out_file);
5867 assemble_name (asm_out_file, p->name);
5868 fprintf (asm_out_file, ", %d\n", p->size);
5875 /* Emit either a label, .comm, or .lcomm directive. When using assembler
5876 macros, mark the symbol as written so that mips_file_end won't emit an
5877 .extern for it. */
5879 void
5880 mips_declare_object (FILE *stream, const char *name, const char *init_string,
5881 const char *final_string, int size)
5883 fputs (init_string, stream); /* "", "\t.comm\t", or "\t.lcomm\t" */
5884 assemble_name (stream, name);
5885 fprintf (stream, final_string, size); /* ":\n", ",%u\n", ",%u\n" */
5887 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
5889 tree name_tree = get_identifier (name);
5890 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
5894 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
5895 extern int size_directive_output;
5897 /* Implement ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME. This is like most of the standard ELF
5898 definitions except that it uses mips_declare_object() to emit the label. */
5900 void
5901 mips_declare_object_name (FILE *stream, const char *name,
5902 tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5904 if (!TARGET_SGI_O32_AS)
5906 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
5907 ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, "object");
5908 #endif
5910 size_directive_output = 0;
5911 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive && DECL_SIZE (decl))
5913 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
5915 size_directive_output = 1;
5916 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5917 ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, size);
5921 mips_declare_object (stream, name, "", ":\n", 0);
5924 /* Implement ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT. This is generic ELF stuff. */
5926 void
5927 mips_finish_declare_object (FILE *stream, tree decl, int top_level, int at_end)
5929 const char *name;
5931 name = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0);
5932 if (!TARGET_SGI_O32_AS
5933 && !flag_inhibit_size_directive
5934 && DECL_SIZE (decl) != 0
5935 && !at_end && top_level
5936 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) == error_mark_node
5937 && !size_directive_output)
5939 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
5941 size_directive_output = 1;
5942 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5943 ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, size);
5946 #endif
5948 /* Return true if X is a small data address that can be rewritten
5949 as a LO_SUM. */
5951 static bool
5952 mips_rewrite_small_data_p (rtx x)
5954 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
5956 return (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
5957 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &symbol_type)
5958 && symbol_type == SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA);
5962 /* A for_each_rtx callback for small_data_pattern. */
5964 static int
5965 small_data_pattern_1 (rtx *loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5967 if (GET_CODE (*loc) == LO_SUM)
5968 return -1;
5970 return mips_rewrite_small_data_p (*loc);
5973 /* Return true if OP refers to small data symbols directly, not through
5974 a LO_SUM. */
5977 small_data_pattern (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5979 return (GET_CODE (op) != SEQUENCE
5980 && for_each_rtx (&op, small_data_pattern_1, 0));
5983 /* A for_each_rtx callback, used by mips_rewrite_small_data. */
5985 static int
5986 mips_rewrite_small_data_1 (rtx *loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5988 if (mips_rewrite_small_data_p (*loc))
5989 *loc = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx, *loc);
5991 if (GET_CODE (*loc) == LO_SUM)
5992 return -1;
5994 return 0;
5997 /* If possible, rewrite OP so that it refers to small data using
5998 explicit relocations. */
6001 mips_rewrite_small_data (rtx op)
6003 op = copy_insn (op);
6004 for_each_rtx (&op, mips_rewrite_small_data_1, 0);
6005 return op;
6008 /* Return true if the current function has an insn that implicitly
6009 refers to $gp. */
6011 static bool
6012 mips_function_has_gp_insn (void)
6014 /* Don't bother rechecking if we found one last time. */
6015 if (!cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p)
6017 rtx insn;
6019 push_topmost_sequence ();
6020 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
6021 if (INSN_P (insn)
6022 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
6023 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
6024 && (get_attr_got (insn) != GOT_UNSET
6025 || small_data_pattern (PATTERN (insn), VOIDmode)))
6026 break;
6027 pop_topmost_sequence ();
6029 cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p = (insn != 0);
6031 return cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p;
6035 /* Return the register that should be used as the global pointer
6036 within this function. Return 0 if the function doesn't need
6037 a global pointer. */
6039 static unsigned int
6040 mips_global_pointer (void)
6042 unsigned int regno;
6044 /* $gp is always available in non-abicalls code. */
6045 if (!TARGET_ABICALLS)
6046 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6048 /* We must always provide $gp when it is used implicitly. */
6049 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
6050 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6052 /* FUNCTION_PROFILER includes a jal macro, so we need to give it
6053 a valid gp. */
6054 if (current_function_profile)
6055 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6057 /* If the function has a nonlocal goto, $gp must hold the correct
6058 global pointer for the target function. */
6059 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_goto)
6060 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6062 /* If the gp is never referenced, there's no need to initialize it.
6063 Note that reload can sometimes introduce constant pool references
6064 into a function that otherwise didn't need them. For example,
6065 suppose we have an instruction like:
6067 (set (reg:DF R1) (float:DF (reg:SI R2)))
6069 If R2 turns out to be constant such as 1, the instruction may have a
6070 REG_EQUAL note saying that R1 == 1.0. Reload then has the option of
6071 using this constant if R2 doesn't get allocated to a register.
6073 In cases like these, reload will have added the constant to the pool
6074 but no instruction will yet refer to it. */
6075 if (!regs_ever_live[GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM]
6076 && !current_function_uses_const_pool
6077 && !mips_function_has_gp_insn ())
6078 return 0;
6080 /* We need a global pointer, but perhaps we can use a call-clobbered
6081 register instead of $gp. */
6082 if (TARGET_NEWABI && current_function_is_leaf)
6083 for (regno = GP_REG_FIRST; regno <= GP_REG_LAST; regno++)
6084 if (!regs_ever_live[regno]
6085 && call_used_regs[regno]
6086 && !fixed_regs[regno]
6087 && regno != PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM)
6088 return regno;
6090 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6094 /* Return true if the current function must save REGNO. */
6096 static bool
6097 mips_save_reg_p (unsigned int regno)
6099 /* We only need to save $gp for NewABI PIC. */
6100 if (regno == GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM)
6101 return (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI
6102 && cfun->machine->global_pointer == regno);
6104 /* Check call-saved registers. */
6105 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
6106 return true;
6108 /* We need to save the old frame pointer before setting up a new one. */
6109 if (regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed)
6110 return true;
6112 /* We need to save the incoming return address if it is ever clobbered
6113 within the function. */
6114 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 31 && regs_ever_live[regno])
6115 return true;
6117 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6119 tree return_type;
6121 return_type = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
6123 /* $18 is a special case in mips16 code. It may be used to call
6124 a function which returns a floating point value, but it is
6125 marked in call_used_regs. */
6126 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 18 && regs_ever_live[regno])
6127 return true;
6129 /* $31 is also a special case. It will be used to copy a return
6130 value into the floating point registers if the return value is
6131 floating point. */
6132 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 31
6133 && mips16_hard_float
6134 && !aggregate_value_p (return_type, current_function_decl)
6135 && GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (return_type)) == MODE_FLOAT
6136 && GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (return_type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
6137 return true;
6140 return false;
6144 /* Return the bytes needed to compute the frame pointer from the current
6145 stack pointer. SIZE is the size (in bytes) of the local variables.
6147 Mips stack frames look like:
6149 Before call After call
6150 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
6151 high | | | |
6152 mem. | | | |
6153 | caller's temps. | | caller's temps. |
6154 | | | |
6155 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
6156 | | | |
6157 | arguments on stack. | | arguments on stack. |
6158 | | | |
6159 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
6160 | 4 words to save | | 4 words to save |
6161 | arguments passed | | arguments passed |
6162 | in registers, even | | in registers, even |
6163 SP->| if not passed. | VFP->| if not passed. |
6164 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
6166 | fp register save |
6168 +-----------------------+
6170 | gp register save |
6172 +-----------------------+
6174 | local variables |
6176 +-----------------------+
6178 | alloca allocations |
6180 +-----------------------+
6182 | GP save for V.4 abi |
6184 +-----------------------+
6186 | arguments on stack |
6188 +-----------------------+
6189 | 4 words to save |
6190 | arguments passed |
6191 | in registers, even |
6192 low SP->| if not passed. |
6193 memory +-----------------------+
6197 HOST_WIDE_INT
6198 compute_frame_size (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
6200 unsigned int regno;
6201 HOST_WIDE_INT total_size; /* # bytes that the entire frame takes up */
6202 HOST_WIDE_INT var_size; /* # bytes that variables take up */
6203 HOST_WIDE_INT args_size; /* # bytes that outgoing arguments take up */
6204 HOST_WIDE_INT cprestore_size; /* # bytes that the cprestore slot takes up */
6205 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_rounded; /* # bytes needed to store gp after rounding */
6206 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store gp regs */
6207 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store fp regs */
6208 unsigned int mask; /* mask of saved gp registers */
6209 unsigned int fmask; /* mask of saved fp registers */
6211 cfun->machine->global_pointer = mips_global_pointer ();
6213 gp_reg_size = 0;
6214 fp_reg_size = 0;
6215 mask = 0;
6216 fmask = 0;
6217 var_size = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (size);
6218 args_size = current_function_outgoing_args_size;
6219 cprestore_size = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET) - args_size;
6221 /* The space set aside by STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET isn't needed in leaf
6222 functions. If the function has local variables, we're committed
6223 to allocating it anyway. Otherwise reclaim it here. */
6224 if (var_size == 0 && current_function_is_leaf)
6225 cprestore_size = args_size = 0;
6227 /* The MIPS 3.0 linker does not like functions that dynamically
6228 allocate the stack and have 0 for STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET, since it
6229 looks like we are trying to create a second frame pointer to the
6230 function, so allocate some stack space to make it happy. */
6232 if (args_size == 0 && current_function_calls_alloca)
6233 args_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6235 total_size = var_size + args_size + cprestore_size;
6237 /* Calculate space needed for gp registers. */
6238 for (regno = GP_REG_FIRST; regno <= GP_REG_LAST; regno++)
6239 if (mips_save_reg_p (regno))
6241 gp_reg_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
6242 mask |= 1 << (regno - GP_REG_FIRST);
6245 /* We need to restore these for the handler. */
6246 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
6248 unsigned int i;
6249 for (i = 0; ; ++i)
6251 regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
6252 if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
6253 break;
6254 gp_reg_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
6255 mask |= 1 << (regno - GP_REG_FIRST);
6259 /* This loop must iterate over the same space as its companion in
6260 save_restore_insns. */
6261 for (regno = (FP_REG_LAST - FP_INC + 1);
6262 regno >= FP_REG_FIRST;
6263 regno -= FP_INC)
6265 if (mips_save_reg_p (regno))
6267 fp_reg_size += FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
6268 fmask |= ((1 << FP_INC) - 1) << (regno - FP_REG_FIRST);
6272 gp_reg_rounded = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (gp_reg_size);
6273 total_size += gp_reg_rounded + MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (fp_reg_size);
6275 /* Add in space reserved on the stack by the callee for storing arguments
6276 passed in registers. */
6277 if (mips_abi != ABI_32 && mips_abi != ABI_O64)
6278 total_size += MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (current_function_pretend_args_size);
6280 /* Save other computed information. */
6281 cfun->machine->frame.total_size = total_size;
6282 cfun->machine->frame.var_size = var_size;
6283 cfun->machine->frame.args_size = args_size;
6284 cfun->machine->frame.cprestore_size = cprestore_size;
6285 cfun->machine->frame.gp_reg_size = gp_reg_size;
6286 cfun->machine->frame.fp_reg_size = fp_reg_size;
6287 cfun->machine->frame.mask = mask;
6288 cfun->machine->frame.fmask = fmask;
6289 cfun->machine->frame.initialized = reload_completed;
6290 cfun->machine->frame.num_gp = gp_reg_size / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6291 cfun->machine->frame.num_fp = fp_reg_size / (FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
6293 if (mask)
6295 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6297 offset = (args_size + cprestore_size + var_size
6298 + gp_reg_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode));
6299 cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset = offset;
6300 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset = offset - total_size;
6302 else
6304 cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset = 0;
6305 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset = 0;
6308 if (fmask)
6310 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6312 offset = (args_size + cprestore_size + var_size
6313 + gp_reg_rounded + fp_reg_size
6314 - FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
6315 cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset = offset;
6316 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset = offset - total_size;
6318 else
6320 cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset = 0;
6321 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset = 0;
6324 /* Ok, we're done. */
6325 return total_size;
6328 /* Implement INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET. FROM is either the frame
6329 pointer or argument pointer. TO is either the stack pointer or
6330 hard frame pointer. */
6332 HOST_WIDE_INT
6333 mips_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
6335 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6337 compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
6339 /* Set OFFSET to the offset from the stack pointer. */
6340 switch (from)
6342 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
6343 offset = 0;
6344 break;
6346 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
6347 offset = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
6348 if (mips_abi == ABI_N32 || mips_abi == ABI_64)
6349 offset -= current_function_pretend_args_size;
6350 break;
6352 default:
6353 abort ();
6356 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
6357 offset -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
6359 return offset;
6362 /* Implement RETURN_ADDR_RTX. Note, we do not support moving
6363 back to a previous frame. */
6365 mips_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6367 if (count != 0)
6368 return const0_rtx;
6370 return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, GP_REG_FIRST + 31);
6373 /* Use FN to save or restore register REGNO. MODE is the register's
6374 mode and OFFSET is the offset of its save slot from the current
6375 stack pointer. */
6377 static void
6378 mips_save_restore_reg (enum machine_mode mode, int regno,
6379 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, mips_save_restore_fn fn)
6381 rtx mem;
6383 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, offset));
6384 if (!current_function_calls_eh_return)
6385 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (mem) = 1;
6387 fn (gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno), mem);
6391 /* Call FN for each register that is saved by the current function.
6392 SP_OFFSET is the offset of the current stack pointer from the start
6393 of the frame. */
6395 static void
6396 mips_for_each_saved_reg (HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset, mips_save_restore_fn fn)
6398 #define BITSET_P(VALUE, BIT) (((VALUE) & (1L << (BIT))) != 0)
6400 enum machine_mode fpr_mode;
6401 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6402 int regno;
6404 /* Save registers starting from high to low. The debuggers prefer at least
6405 the return register be stored at func+4, and also it allows us not to
6406 need a nop in the epilog if at least one register is reloaded in
6407 addition to return address. */
6408 offset = cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset - sp_offset;
6409 for (regno = GP_REG_LAST; regno >= GP_REG_FIRST; regno--)
6410 if (BITSET_P (cfun->machine->frame.mask, regno - GP_REG_FIRST))
6412 mips_save_restore_reg (gpr_mode, regno, offset, fn);
6413 offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
6416 /* This loop must iterate over the same space as its companion in
6417 compute_frame_size. */
6418 offset = cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset - sp_offset;
6419 fpr_mode = (TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT ? SFmode : DFmode);
6420 for (regno = (FP_REG_LAST - FP_INC + 1);
6421 regno >= FP_REG_FIRST;
6422 regno -= FP_INC)
6423 if (BITSET_P (cfun->machine->frame.fmask, regno - FP_REG_FIRST))
6425 mips_save_restore_reg (fpr_mode, regno, offset, fn);
6426 offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (fpr_mode);
6428 #undef BITSET_P
6431 /* Set up the stack and frame (if desired) for the function. */
6433 static void
6434 mips_output_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6436 const char *fnname;
6437 HOST_WIDE_INT tsize = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
6439 /* ??? When is this really needed? At least the GNU assembler does not
6440 need the source filename more than once in the file, beyond what is
6441 emitted by the debug information. */
6442 if (!TARGET_GAS)
6443 ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (file, DECL_SOURCE_FILE (current_function_decl));
6445 #ifdef SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
6446 if (debug_info_level != DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE && write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG)
6447 ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (file, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (current_function_decl), 0);
6448 #endif
6450 /* In mips16 mode, we may need to generate a 32 bit to handle
6451 floating point arguments. The linker will arrange for any 32 bit
6452 functions to call this stub, which will then jump to the 16 bit
6453 function proper. */
6454 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
6455 && current_function_args_info.fp_code != 0)
6456 build_mips16_function_stub (file);
6458 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
6460 /* Get the function name the same way that toplev.c does before calling
6461 assemble_start_function. This is needed so that the name used here
6462 exactly matches the name used in ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
6463 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
6465 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
6467 fputs ("\t.ent\t", file);
6468 assemble_name (file, fnname);
6469 fputs ("\n", file);
6472 assemble_name (file, fnname);
6473 fputs (":\n", file);
6476 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
6478 /* .frame FRAMEREG, FRAMESIZE, RETREG */
6479 fprintf (file,
6480 "\t.frame\t%s," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",%s\t\t"
6481 "# vars= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ", regs= %d/%d"
6482 ", args= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
6483 ", gp= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
6484 (reg_names[(frame_pointer_needed)
6485 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM]),
6486 ((frame_pointer_needed && TARGET_MIPS16)
6487 ? tsize - cfun->machine->frame.args_size
6488 : tsize),
6489 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 31],
6490 cfun->machine->frame.var_size,
6491 cfun->machine->frame.num_gp,
6492 cfun->machine->frame.num_fp,
6493 cfun->machine->frame.args_size,
6494 cfun->machine->frame.cprestore_size);
6496 /* .mask MASK, GPOFFSET; .fmask FPOFFSET */
6497 fprintf (file, "\t.mask\t0x%08x," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
6498 cfun->machine->frame.mask,
6499 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset);
6500 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask\t0x%08x," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
6501 cfun->machine->frame.fmask,
6502 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset);
6504 /* Require:
6505 OLD_SP == *FRAMEREG + FRAMESIZE => can find old_sp from nominated FP reg.
6506 HIGHEST_GP_SAVED == *FRAMEREG + FRAMESIZE + GPOFFSET => can find saved regs. */
6509 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && !TARGET_NEWABI && cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
6511 /* Handle the initialization of $gp for SVR4 PIC. */
6512 if (!cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6513 output_asm_insn ("%(.cpload\t%^%)", 0);
6514 else
6515 output_asm_insn ("%(.cpload\t%^\n\t%<", 0);
6517 else if (cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6518 output_asm_insn ("%(%<", 0);
6521 /* Make the last instruction frame related and note that it performs
6522 the operation described by FRAME_PATTERN. */
6524 static void
6525 mips_set_frame_expr (rtx frame_pattern)
6527 rtx insn;
6529 insn = get_last_insn ();
6530 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
6531 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
6532 frame_pattern,
6533 REG_NOTES (insn));
6537 /* Return a frame-related rtx that stores REG at MEM.
6538 REG must be a single register. */
6540 static rtx
6541 mips_frame_set (rtx mem, rtx reg)
6543 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, reg);
6544 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
6545 return set;
6549 /* Save register REG to MEM. Make the instruction frame-related. */
6551 static void
6552 mips_save_reg (rtx reg, rtx mem)
6554 if (GET_MODE (reg) == DFmode && !TARGET_FLOAT64)
6556 rtx x1, x2;
6558 if (mips_split_64bit_move_p (mem, reg))
6559 mips_split_64bit_move (mem, reg);
6560 else
6561 emit_move_insn (mem, reg);
6563 x1 = mips_frame_set (mips_subword (mem, 0), mips_subword (reg, 0));
6564 x2 = mips_frame_set (mips_subword (mem, 1), mips_subword (reg, 1));
6565 mips_set_frame_expr (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, x1, x2)));
6567 else
6569 if (TARGET_MIPS16
6570 && REGNO (reg) != GP_REG_FIRST + 31
6571 && !M16_REG_P (REGNO (reg)))
6573 /* Save a non-mips16 register by moving it through a temporary.
6574 We don't need to do this for $31 since there's a special
6575 instruction for it. */
6576 emit_move_insn (MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)), reg);
6577 emit_move_insn (mem, MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)));
6579 else
6580 emit_move_insn (mem, reg);
6582 mips_set_frame_expr (mips_frame_set (mem, reg));
6587 /* Expand the prologue into a bunch of separate insns. */
6589 void
6590 mips_expand_prologue (void)
6592 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
6594 if (cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
6595 REGNO (pic_offset_table_rtx) = cfun->machine->global_pointer;
6597 size = compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
6599 /* Save the registers. Allocate up to MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP
6600 bytes beforehand; this is enough to cover the register save area
6601 without going out of range. */
6602 if ((cfun->machine->frame.mask | cfun->machine->frame.fmask) != 0)
6604 HOST_WIDE_INT step1;
6606 step1 = MIN (size, MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP);
6607 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6608 stack_pointer_rtx,
6609 GEN_INT (-step1)))) = 1;
6610 size -= step1;
6611 mips_for_each_saved_reg (size, mips_save_reg);
6614 /* Allocate the rest of the frame. */
6615 if (size > 0)
6617 if (SMALL_OPERAND (-size))
6618 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6619 stack_pointer_rtx,
6620 GEN_INT (-size)))) = 1;
6621 else
6623 emit_move_insn (MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), GEN_INT (size));
6624 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6626 /* There are no instructions to add or subtract registers
6627 from the stack pointer, so use the frame pointer as a
6628 temporary. We should always be using a frame pointer
6629 in this case anyway. */
6630 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
6631 abort ();
6633 emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx);
6634 emit_insn (gen_sub3_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6635 hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6636 MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode)));
6637 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
6639 else
6640 emit_insn (gen_sub3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6641 stack_pointer_rtx,
6642 MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode)));
6644 /* Describe the combined effect of the previous instructions. */
6645 mips_set_frame_expr
6646 (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
6647 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -size)));
6651 /* Set up the frame pointer, if we're using one. In mips16 code,
6652 we point the frame pointer ahead of the outgoing argument area.
6653 This should allow more variables & incoming arguments to be
6654 accessed with unextended instructions. */
6655 if (frame_pointer_needed)
6657 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && cfun->machine->frame.args_size != 0)
6659 rtx offset = GEN_INT (cfun->machine->frame.args_size);
6660 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
6661 (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6662 stack_pointer_rtx,
6663 offset))) = 1;
6665 else
6666 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6667 stack_pointer_rtx)) = 1;
6670 /* If generating o32/o64 abicalls, save $gp on the stack. */
6671 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && !TARGET_NEWABI && !current_function_is_leaf)
6672 emit_insn (gen_cprestore (GEN_INT (current_function_outgoing_args_size)));
6674 /* If generating n32/n64 abicalls, emit the instructions to load $gp. */
6675 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI && cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
6677 rtx addr, offset, incoming_address;
6679 addr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0);
6680 offset = mips_unspec_address (addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP);
6681 incoming_address = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM);
6682 emit_insn (gen_loadgp (offset, incoming_address));
6683 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
6684 emit_insn (gen_loadgp_blockage ());
6687 /* If we are profiling, make sure no instructions are scheduled before
6688 the call to mcount. */
6690 if (current_function_profile)
6691 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
6694 /* Do any necessary cleanup after a function to restore stack, frame,
6695 and regs. */
6697 #define RA_MASK BITMASK_HIGH /* 1 << 31 */
6698 #define PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_MASK (1 << (PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM - GP_REG_FIRST))
6700 static void
6701 mips_output_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6702 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6704 rtx string;
6706 if (cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6708 /* Avoid using %>%) since it adds excess whitespace. */
6709 output_asm_insn (".set\tmacro", 0);
6710 output_asm_insn (".set\treorder", 0);
6711 set_noreorder = set_nomacro = 0;
6714 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
6716 const char *fnname;
6718 /* Get the function name the same way that toplev.c does before calling
6719 assemble_start_function. This is needed so that the name used here
6720 exactly matches the name used in ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
6721 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
6722 fputs ("\t.end\t", file);
6723 assemble_name (file, fnname);
6724 fputs ("\n", file);
6727 while (string_constants != NULL)
6729 struct string_constant *next;
6731 next = string_constants->next;
6732 free (string_constants);
6733 string_constants = next;
6736 /* If any following function uses the same strings as this one, force
6737 them to refer those strings indirectly. Nearby functions could
6738 refer them using pc-relative addressing, but it isn't safe in
6739 general. For instance, some functions may be placed in sections
6740 other than .text, and we don't know whether they be close enough
6741 to this one. In large files, even other .text functions can be
6742 too far away. */
6743 for (string = mips16_strings; string != 0; string = XEXP (string, 1))
6744 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (XEXP (string, 0)) = 0;
6745 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&mips16_strings);
6747 /* Reinstate the normal $gp. */
6748 REGNO (pic_offset_table_rtx) = GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6751 /* Emit instructions to restore register REG from slot MEM. */
6753 static void
6754 mips_restore_reg (rtx reg, rtx mem)
6756 /* There's no mips16 instruction to load $31 directly. Load into
6757 $7 instead and adjust the return insn appropriately. */
6758 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && REGNO (reg) == GP_REG_FIRST + 31)
6759 reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), 7);
6761 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && !M16_REG_P (REGNO (reg)))
6763 /* Can't restore directly; move through a temporary. */
6764 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)), mem);
6765 emit_move_insn (reg, MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)));
6767 else
6768 emit_move_insn (reg, mem);
6772 /* Expand the epilogue into a bunch of separate insns. SIBCALL_P is true
6773 if this epilogue precedes a sibling call, false if it is for a normal
6774 "epilogue" pattern. */
6776 void
6777 mips_expand_epilogue (int sibcall_p)
6779 HOST_WIDE_INT step1, step2;
6780 rtx base, target;
6782 if (!sibcall_p && mips_can_use_return_insn ())
6784 emit_jump_insn (gen_return ());
6785 return;
6788 /* Split the frame into two. STEP1 is the amount of stack we should
6789 deallocate before restoring the registers. STEP2 is the amount we
6790 should deallocate afterwards.
6792 Start off by assuming that no registers need to be restored. */
6793 step1 = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
6794 step2 = 0;
6796 /* Work out which register holds the frame address. Account for the
6797 frame pointer offset used by mips16 code. */
6798 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
6799 base = stack_pointer_rtx;
6800 else
6802 base = hard_frame_pointer_rtx;
6803 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6804 step1 -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
6807 /* If we need to restore registers, deallocate as much stack as
6808 possible in the second step without going out of range. */
6809 if ((cfun->machine->frame.mask | cfun->machine->frame.fmask) != 0)
6811 step2 = MIN (step1, MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP);
6812 step1 -= step2;
6815 /* Set TARGET to BASE + STEP1. */
6816 target = base;
6817 if (step1 > 0)
6819 rtx adjust;
6821 /* Get an rtx for STEP1 that we can add to BASE. */
6822 adjust = GEN_INT (step1);
6823 if (!SMALL_OPERAND (step1))
6825 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), adjust);
6826 adjust = MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode);
6829 /* Normal mode code can copy the result straight into $sp. */
6830 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
6831 target = stack_pointer_rtx;
6833 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (target, base, adjust));
6836 /* Copy TARGET into the stack pointer. */
6837 if (target != stack_pointer_rtx)
6838 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, target);
6840 /* If we're using addressing macros for n32/n64 abicalls, $gp is
6841 implicitly used by all SYMBOL_REFs. We must emit a blockage
6842 insn before restoring it. */
6843 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI && !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
6844 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
6846 /* Restore the registers. */
6847 mips_for_each_saved_reg (cfun->machine->frame.total_size - step2,
6848 mips_restore_reg);
6850 /* Deallocate the final bit of the frame. */
6851 if (step2 > 0)
6852 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6853 stack_pointer_rtx,
6854 GEN_INT (step2)));
6856 /* Add in the __builtin_eh_return stack adjustment. We need to
6857 use a temporary in mips16 code. */
6858 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
6860 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6862 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), stack_pointer_rtx);
6863 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode),
6864 MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode),
6865 EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
6866 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode));
6868 else
6869 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6870 stack_pointer_rtx,
6871 EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
6874 if (!sibcall_p)
6876 /* The mips16 loads the return address into $7, not $31. */
6877 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && (cfun->machine->frame.mask & RA_MASK) != 0)
6878 emit_jump_insn (gen_return_internal (gen_rtx (REG, Pmode,
6879 GP_REG_FIRST + 7)));
6880 else
6881 emit_jump_insn (gen_return_internal (gen_rtx (REG, Pmode,
6882 GP_REG_FIRST + 31)));
6886 /* Return nonzero if this function is known to have a null epilogue.
6887 This allows the optimizer to omit jumps to jumps if no stack
6888 was created. */
6891 mips_can_use_return_insn (void)
6893 tree return_type;
6895 if (! reload_completed)
6896 return 0;
6898 if (regs_ever_live[31] || current_function_profile)
6899 return 0;
6901 return_type = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
6903 /* In mips16 mode, a function which returns a floating point value
6904 needs to arrange to copy the return value into the floating point
6905 registers. */
6906 if (TARGET_MIPS16
6907 && mips16_hard_float
6908 && ! aggregate_value_p (return_type, current_function_decl)
6909 && GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (return_type)) == MODE_FLOAT
6910 && GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (return_type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
6911 return 0;
6913 if (cfun->machine->frame.initialized)
6914 return cfun->machine->frame.total_size == 0;
6916 return compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ()) == 0;
6919 /* Returns nonzero if X contains a SYMBOL_REF. */
6921 static int
6922 symbolic_expression_p (rtx x)
6924 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
6925 return 1;
6927 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
6928 return symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0));
6930 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x)) == '1')
6931 return symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0));
6933 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x)) == 'c'
6934 || GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x)) == '2')
6935 return (symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0))
6936 || symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 1)));
6938 return 0;
6941 /* Choose the section to use for the constant rtx expression X that has
6942 mode MODE. */
6944 static void
6945 mips_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x,
6946 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align)
6948 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6950 /* In mips16 mode, the constant table always goes in the same section
6951 as the function, so that constants can be loaded using PC relative
6952 addressing. */
6953 function_section (current_function_decl);
6955 else if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_DATA)
6957 /* For embedded applications, always put constants in read-only data,
6958 in order to reduce RAM usage. */
6959 mergeable_constant_section (mode, align, 0);
6961 else
6963 /* For hosted applications, always put constants in small data if
6964 possible, as this gives the best performance. */
6965 /* ??? Consider using mergeable small data sections. */
6967 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= (unsigned) mips_section_threshold
6968 && mips_section_threshold > 0)
6969 named_section (0, ".sdata", 0);
6970 else if (flag_pic && symbolic_expression_p (x))
6972 if (targetm.have_named_sections)
6973 named_section (0, ".data.rel.ro", 3);
6974 else
6975 data_section ();
6977 else
6978 mergeable_constant_section (mode, align, 0);
6982 /* Choose the section to use for DECL. RELOC is true if its value contains
6983 any relocatable expression. */
6985 static void
6986 mips_select_section (tree decl, int reloc,
6987 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6989 if ((TARGET_EMBEDDED_PIC || TARGET_MIPS16)
6990 && TREE_CODE (decl) == STRING_CST
6991 && !flag_writable_strings)
6992 /* For embedded position independent code, put constant strings in the
6993 text section, because the data section is limited to 64K in size.
6994 For mips16 code, put strings in the text section so that a PC
6995 relative load instruction can be used to get their address. */
6996 text_section ();
6997 else if (targetm.have_named_sections)
6998 default_elf_select_section (decl, reloc, align);
6999 else
7000 /* The native irix o32 assembler doesn't support named sections. */
7001 default_select_section (decl, reloc, align);
7005 /* Implement TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P. Return true if it would be safe to
7006 access DECL using %gp_rel(...)($gp). */
7008 static bool
7009 mips_in_small_data_p (tree decl)
7011 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
7013 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == STRING_CST || TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
7014 return false;
7016 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) != 0)
7018 const char *name;
7020 /* Reject anything that isn't in a known small-data section. */
7021 name = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl));
7022 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") != 0 && strcmp (name, ".sbss") != 0)
7023 return false;
7025 /* If a symbol is defined externally, the assembler will use the
7026 usual -G rules when deciding how to implement macros. */
7027 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS || !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
7028 return true;
7030 else if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_DATA)
7032 /* Don't put constants into the small data section: we want them
7033 to be in ROM rather than RAM. */
7034 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL)
7035 return false;
7037 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
7038 && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (decl)
7039 && (!DECL_INITIAL (decl) || TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_INITIAL (decl))))
7040 return false;
7043 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
7044 return (size > 0 && size <= mips_section_threshold);
7048 /* When generating embedded PIC code, SYMBOL_REF_FLAG is set for
7049 symbols which are not in the .text section.
7051 When generating mips16 code, SYMBOL_REF_FLAG is set for string
7052 constants which are put in the .text section. We also record the
7053 total length of all such strings; this total is used to decide
7054 whether we need to split the constant table, and need not be
7055 precisely correct.
7057 When generating -mabicalls code, SYMBOL_REF_FLAG is set if we
7058 should treat the symbol as SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL. */
7060 static void
7061 mips_encode_section_info (tree decl, rtx rtl, int first)
7063 rtx symbol;
7065 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != MEM)
7066 return;
7068 symbol = XEXP (rtl, 0);
7070 if (GET_CODE (symbol) != SYMBOL_REF)
7071 return;
7073 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
7075 if (first && TREE_CODE (decl) == STRING_CST
7076 && ! flag_writable_strings
7077 /* If this string is from a function, and the function will
7078 go in a gnu linkonce section, then we can't directly
7079 access the string. This gets an assembler error
7080 "unsupported PC relative reference to different section".
7081 If we modify SELECT_SECTION to put it in function_section
7082 instead of text_section, it still fails because
7083 DECL_SECTION_NAME isn't set until assemble_start_function.
7084 If we fix that, it still fails because strings are shared
7085 among multiple functions, and we have cross section
7086 references again. We force it to work by putting string
7087 addresses in the constant pool and indirecting. */
7088 && (! current_function_decl
7089 || ! DECL_ONE_ONLY (current_function_decl)))
7091 mips16_strings = alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, symbol, mips16_strings);
7092 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 1;
7093 mips_string_length += TREE_STRING_LENGTH (decl);
7097 if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_PIC)
7099 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
7100 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 1;
7101 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
7102 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 0;
7103 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == STRING_CST
7104 && ! flag_writable_strings)
7105 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 0;
7106 else
7107 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 1;
7110 else if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
7112 /* Mark the symbol if we should treat it as SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL.
7113 There are three cases to consider:
7115 - o32 PIC (either with or without explicit relocs)
7116 - n32/n64 PIC without explicit relocs
7117 - n32/n64 PIC with explicit relocs
7119 In the first case, both local and global accesses will use an
7120 R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation. We must correctly predict which of
7121 the two semantics (local or global) the assembler and linker
7122 will apply. The choice doesn't depend on the symbol's
7123 visibility, so we deliberately ignore decl_visibility and
7124 binds_local_p here.
7126 In the second case, the assembler will not use R_MIPS_GOT16
7127 relocations, but it chooses between local and global accesses
7128 in the same way as for o32 PIC.
7130 In the third case we have more freedom since both forms of
7131 access will work for any kind of symbol. However, there seems
7132 little point in doing things differently. */
7133 if (DECL_P (decl) && TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7134 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 0;
7135 else
7136 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (symbol) = 1;
7139 default_encode_section_info (decl, rtl, first);
7142 /* See whether VALTYPE is a record whose fields should be returned in
7143 floating-point registers. If so, return the number of fields and
7144 list them in FIELDS (which should have two elements). Return 0
7145 otherwise.
7147 For n32 & n64, a structure with one or two fields is returned in
7148 floating-point registers as long as every field has a floating-point
7149 type. */
7151 static int
7152 mips_fpr_return_fields (tree valtype, tree *fields)
7154 tree field;
7155 int i;
7157 if (!TARGET_NEWABI)
7158 return 0;
7160 if (TREE_CODE (valtype) != RECORD_TYPE)
7161 return 0;
7163 i = 0;
7164 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (valtype); field != 0; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
7166 if (TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL)
7167 continue;
7169 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) != REAL_TYPE)
7170 return 0;
7172 if (i == 2)
7173 return 0;
7175 fields[i++] = field;
7177 return i;
7181 /* Implement TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB. For n32 & n64, we should return
7182 a value in the most significant part of $2/$3 if:
7184 - the target is big-endian;
7186 - the value has a structure or union type (we generalize this to
7187 cover aggregates from other languages too); and
7189 - the structure is not returned in floating-point registers. */
7191 static bool
7192 mips_return_in_msb (tree valtype)
7194 tree fields[2];
7196 return (TARGET_NEWABI
7197 && TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN
7198 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)
7199 && mips_fpr_return_fields (valtype, fields) == 0);
7203 /* Return a composite value in a pair of floating-point registers.
7204 MODE1 and OFFSET1 are the mode and byte offset for the first value,
7205 likewise MODE2 and OFFSET2 for the second. MODE is the mode of the
7206 complete value.
7208 For n32 & n64, $f0 always holds the first value and $f2 the second.
7209 Otherwise the values are packed together as closely as possible. */
7211 static rtx
7212 mips_return_fpr_pair (enum machine_mode mode,
7213 enum machine_mode mode1, HOST_WIDE_INT offset1,
7214 enum machine_mode mode2, HOST_WIDE_INT offset2)
7216 int inc;
7218 inc = (TARGET_NEWABI ? 2 : FP_INC);
7219 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL
7220 (mode,
7221 gen_rtvec (2,
7222 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
7223 gen_rtx_REG (mode1, FP_RETURN),
7224 GEN_INT (offset1)),
7225 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
7226 gen_rtx_REG (mode2, FP_RETURN + inc),
7227 GEN_INT (offset2))));
7232 /* Implement FUNCTION_VALUE and LIBCALL_VALUE. For normal calls,
7233 VALTYPE is the return type and MODE is VOIDmode. For libcalls,
7234 VALTYPE is null and MODE is the mode of the return value. */
7237 mips_function_value (tree valtype, tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7238 enum machine_mode mode)
7240 if (valtype)
7242 tree fields[2];
7243 int unsignedp;
7245 mode = TYPE_MODE (valtype);
7246 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (valtype);
7248 /* Since we define PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN, we must promote
7249 the mode just as PROMOTE_MODE does. */
7250 mode = promote_mode (valtype, mode, &unsignedp, 1);
7252 /* Handle structures whose fields are returned in $f0/$f2. */
7253 switch (mips_fpr_return_fields (valtype, fields))
7255 case 1:
7256 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_RETURN);
7258 case 2:
7259 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
7260 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fields[0])),
7261 int_byte_position (fields[0]),
7262 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fields[1])),
7263 int_byte_position (fields[1]));
7266 /* If a value is passed in the most significant part of a register, see
7267 whether we have to round the mode up to a whole number of words. */
7268 if (mips_return_in_msb (valtype))
7270 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (valtype);
7271 if (size % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0)
7273 size += UNITS_PER_WORD - size % UNITS_PER_WORD;
7274 mode = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0);
7279 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
7280 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE)
7281 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_RETURN);
7283 /* Handle long doubles for n32 & n64. */
7284 if (mode == TFmode)
7285 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
7286 DImode, 0,
7287 DImode, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 2);
7289 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
7290 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE * 2)
7291 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
7292 GET_MODE_INNER (mode), 0,
7293 GET_MODE_INNER (mode),
7294 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 2);
7296 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, GP_RETURN);
7299 /* The implementation of FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE. Return
7300 nonzero when an argument must be passed by reference. */
7303 function_arg_pass_by_reference (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7304 enum machine_mode mode, tree type,
7305 int named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7307 int size;
7309 /* The EABI is the only one to pass args by reference. */
7310 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI)
7311 return 0;
7313 /* ??? How should SCmode be handled? */
7314 if (type == NULL_TREE || mode == DImode || mode == DFmode)
7315 return 0;
7317 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
7318 return size == -1 || size > UNITS_PER_WORD;
7321 /* Return the class of registers for which a mode change from FROM to TO
7322 is invalid.
7324 In little-endian mode, the hi-lo registers are numbered backwards,
7325 so (subreg:SI (reg:DI hi) 0) gets the high word instead of the low
7326 word as intended.
7328 Similarly, when using paired floating-point registers, the first
7329 register holds the low word, regardless of endianness. So in big
7330 endian mode, (subreg:SI (reg:DF $f0) 0) does not get the high word
7331 as intended.
7333 Also, loading a 32-bit value into a 64-bit floating-point register
7334 will not sign-extend the value, despite what LOAD_EXTEND_OP says.
7335 We can't allow 64-bit float registers to change from a 32-bit
7336 mode to a 64-bit mode. */
7338 bool
7339 mips_cannot_change_mode_class (enum machine_mode from,
7340 enum machine_mode to, enum reg_class class)
7342 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) != GET_MODE_SIZE (to))
7344 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
7345 return reg_classes_intersect_p (FP_REGS, class);
7346 if (TARGET_FLOAT64)
7347 return reg_classes_intersect_p (HI_AND_FP_REGS, class);
7348 return reg_classes_intersect_p (HI_REG, class);
7350 return false;
7353 /* This function returns the register class required for a secondary
7354 register when copying between one of the registers in CLASS, and X,
7355 using MODE. If IN_P is nonzero, the copy is going from X to the
7356 register, otherwise the register is the source. A return value of
7357 NO_REGS means that no secondary register is required. */
7359 enum reg_class
7360 mips_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class class,
7361 enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int in_p)
7363 enum reg_class gr_regs = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REGS : GR_REGS;
7364 int regno = -1;
7365 int gp_reg_p;
7367 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG || GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7368 regno = true_regnum (x);
7370 gp_reg_p = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REG_P (regno) : GP_REG_P (regno);
7372 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], 25)
7373 && DANGEROUS_FOR_LA25_P (x))
7374 return LEA_REGS;
7376 /* Copying from HI or LO to anywhere other than a general register
7377 requires a general register. */
7378 if (class == HI_REG || class == LO_REG || class == MD_REGS)
7380 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && in_p)
7382 /* We can't really copy to HI or LO at all in mips16 mode. */
7383 return M16_REGS;
7385 return gp_reg_p ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
7387 if (MD_REG_P (regno))
7389 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && ! in_p)
7391 /* We can't really copy to HI or LO at all in mips16 mode. */
7392 return M16_REGS;
7394 return class == gr_regs ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
7397 /* We can only copy a value to a condition code register from a
7398 floating point register, and even then we require a scratch
7399 floating point register. We can only copy a value out of a
7400 condition code register into a general register. */
7401 if (class == ST_REGS)
7403 if (in_p)
7404 return FP_REGS;
7405 return GP_REG_P (regno) ? NO_REGS : GR_REGS;
7407 if (ST_REG_P (regno))
7409 if (! in_p)
7410 return FP_REGS;
7411 return class == GR_REGS ? NO_REGS : GR_REGS;
7414 if (class == FP_REGS)
7416 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
7418 /* In this case we can use lwc1, swc1, ldc1 or sdc1. */
7419 return NO_REGS;
7421 else if (CONSTANT_P (x) && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
7423 /* We can use the l.s and l.d macros to load floating-point
7424 constants. ??? For l.s, we could probably get better
7425 code by returning GR_REGS here. */
7426 return NO_REGS;
7428 else if (GP_REG_P (regno) || x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
7430 /* In this case we can use mtc1, mfc1, dmtc1 or dmfc1. */
7431 return NO_REGS;
7433 else if (FP_REG_P (regno))
7435 /* In this case we can use mov.s or mov.d. */
7436 return NO_REGS;
7438 else
7440 /* Otherwise, we need to reload through an integer register. */
7441 return GR_REGS;
7445 /* In mips16 mode, going between memory and anything but M16_REGS
7446 requires an M16_REG. */
7447 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
7449 if (class != M16_REGS && class != M16_NA_REGS)
7451 if (gp_reg_p)
7452 return NO_REGS;
7453 return M16_REGS;
7455 if (! gp_reg_p)
7457 if (class == M16_REGS || class == M16_NA_REGS)
7458 return NO_REGS;
7459 return M16_REGS;
7463 return NO_REGS;
7466 /* Implement CLASS_MAX_NREGS.
7468 Usually all registers are word-sized. The only supported exception
7469 is -mgp64 -msingle-float, which has 64-bit words but 32-bit float
7470 registers. A word-based calculation is correct even in that case,
7471 since -msingle-float disallows multi-FPR values. */
7474 mips_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class class ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7475 enum machine_mode mode)
7477 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
7480 bool
7481 mips_valid_pointer_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
7483 return (mode == SImode || (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode));
7487 /* If we can access small data directly (using gp-relative relocation
7488 operators) return the small data pointer, otherwise return null.
7490 For each mips16 function which refers to GP relative symbols, we
7491 use a pseudo register, initialized at the start of the function, to
7492 hold the $gp value. */
7494 static rtx
7495 mips16_gp_pseudo_reg (void)
7497 if (cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx == NULL_RTX)
7499 rtx const_gp;
7500 rtx insn, scan;
7502 cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
7503 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx) = 1;
7505 /* We want to initialize this to a value which gcc will believe
7506 is constant. */
7507 const_gp = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx);
7508 start_sequence ();
7509 emit_move_insn (cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx,
7510 const_gp);
7511 insn = get_insns ();
7512 end_sequence ();
7514 push_topmost_sequence ();
7515 /* We need to emit the initialization after the FUNCTION_BEG
7516 note, so that it will be integrated. */
7517 for (scan = get_insns (); scan != NULL_RTX; scan = NEXT_INSN (scan))
7518 if (GET_CODE (scan) == NOTE
7519 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (scan) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG)
7520 break;
7521 if (scan == NULL_RTX)
7522 scan = get_insns ();
7523 insn = emit_insn_after (insn, scan);
7524 pop_topmost_sequence ();
7527 return cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx;
7530 /* Write out code to move floating point arguments in or out of
7531 general registers. Output the instructions to FILE. FP_CODE is
7532 the code describing which arguments are present (see the comment at
7533 the definition of CUMULATIVE_ARGS in mips.h). FROM_FP_P is nonzero if
7534 we are copying from the floating point registers. */
7536 static void
7537 mips16_fp_args (FILE *file, int fp_code, int from_fp_p)
7539 const char *s;
7540 int gparg, fparg;
7541 unsigned int f;
7543 /* This code only works for the original 32 bit ABI and the O64 ABI. */
7544 if (mips_abi != ABI_32 && mips_abi != ABI_O64)
7545 abort ();
7547 if (from_fp_p)
7548 s = "mfc1";
7549 else
7550 s = "mtc1";
7551 gparg = GP_ARG_FIRST;
7552 fparg = FP_ARG_FIRST;
7553 for (f = (unsigned int) fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7555 if ((f & 3) == 1)
7557 if ((fparg & 1) != 0)
7558 ++fparg;
7559 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7560 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg]);
7562 else if ((f & 3) == 2)
7564 if (TARGET_64BIT)
7565 fprintf (file, "\td%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7566 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg]);
7567 else
7569 if ((fparg & 1) != 0)
7570 ++fparg;
7571 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
7572 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7573 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg + 1], s,
7574 reg_names[gparg + 1], reg_names[fparg]);
7575 else
7576 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7577 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg], s,
7578 reg_names[gparg + 1], reg_names[fparg + 1]);
7579 ++gparg;
7580 ++fparg;
7583 else
7584 abort ();
7586 ++gparg;
7587 ++fparg;
7591 /* Build a mips16 function stub. This is used for functions which
7592 take arguments in the floating point registers. It is 32 bit code
7593 that moves the floating point args into the general registers, and
7594 then jumps to the 16 bit code. */
7596 static void
7597 build_mips16_function_stub (FILE *file)
7599 const char *fnname;
7600 char *secname, *stubname;
7601 tree stubid, stubdecl;
7602 int need_comma;
7603 unsigned int f;
7605 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
7606 secname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7607 sprintf (secname, ".mips16.fn.%s", fnname);
7608 stubname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7609 sprintf (stubname, "__fn_stub_%s", fnname);
7610 stubid = get_identifier (stubname);
7611 stubdecl = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, stubid,
7612 build_function_type (void_type_node, NULL_TREE));
7613 DECL_SECTION_NAME (stubdecl) = build_string (strlen (secname), secname);
7615 fprintf (file, "\t# Stub function for %s (", current_function_name);
7616 need_comma = 0;
7617 for (f = (unsigned int) current_function_args_info.fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7619 fprintf (file, "%s%s",
7620 need_comma ? ", " : "",
7621 (f & 3) == 1 ? "float" : "double");
7622 need_comma = 1;
7624 fprintf (file, ")\n");
7626 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tnomips16\n");
7627 function_section (stubdecl);
7628 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (file, floor_log2 (FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT));
7630 /* ??? If FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED is defined, then we are
7631 within a .ent, and we can not emit another .ent. */
7632 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7634 fputs ("\t.ent\t", file);
7635 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7636 fputs ("\n", file);
7639 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7640 fputs (":\n", file);
7642 /* We don't want the assembler to insert any nops here. */
7643 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tnoreorder\n");
7645 mips16_fp_args (file, current_function_args_info.fp_code, 1);
7647 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoat\n");
7648 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tla\t%s,", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7649 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7650 fprintf (file, "\n");
7651 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjr\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7652 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tat\n");
7654 /* Unfortunately, we can't fill the jump delay slot. We can't fill
7655 with one of the mfc1 instructions, because the result is not
7656 available for one instruction, so if the very first instruction
7657 in the function refers to the register, it will see the wrong
7658 value. */
7659 fprintf (file, "\tnop\n");
7661 fprintf (file, "\t.set\treorder\n");
7663 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7665 fputs ("\t.end\t", file);
7666 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7667 fputs ("\n", file);
7670 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
7672 function_section (current_function_decl);
7675 /* We keep a list of functions for which we have already built stubs
7676 in build_mips16_call_stub. */
7678 struct mips16_stub
7680 struct mips16_stub *next;
7681 char *name;
7682 int fpret;
7685 static struct mips16_stub *mips16_stubs;
7687 /* Build a call stub for a mips16 call. A stub is needed if we are
7688 passing any floating point values which should go into the floating
7689 point registers. If we are, and the call turns out to be to a 32
7690 bit function, the stub will be used to move the values into the
7691 floating point registers before calling the 32 bit function. The
7692 linker will magically adjust the function call to either the 16 bit
7693 function or the 32 bit stub, depending upon where the function call
7694 is actually defined.
7696 Similarly, we need a stub if the return value might come back in a
7697 floating point register.
7699 RETVAL is the location of the return value, or null if this is
7700 a call rather than a call_value. FN is the address of the
7701 function and ARG_SIZE is the size of the arguments. FP_CODE
7702 is the code built by function_arg. This function returns a nonzero
7703 value if it builds the call instruction itself. */
7706 build_mips16_call_stub (rtx retval, rtx fn, rtx arg_size, int fp_code)
7708 int fpret;
7709 const char *fnname;
7710 char *secname, *stubname;
7711 struct mips16_stub *l;
7712 tree stubid, stubdecl;
7713 int need_comma;
7714 unsigned int f;
7716 /* We don't need to do anything if we aren't in mips16 mode, or if
7717 we were invoked with the -msoft-float option. */
7718 if (! TARGET_MIPS16 || ! mips16_hard_float)
7719 return 0;
7721 /* Figure out whether the value might come back in a floating point
7722 register. */
7723 fpret = (retval != 0
7724 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (retval)) == MODE_FLOAT
7725 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (retval)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
7727 /* We don't need to do anything if there were no floating point
7728 arguments and the value will not be returned in a floating point
7729 register. */
7730 if (fp_code == 0 && ! fpret)
7731 return 0;
7733 /* We don't need to do anything if this is a call to a special
7734 mips16 support function. */
7735 if (GET_CODE (fn) == SYMBOL_REF
7736 && strncmp (XSTR (fn, 0), "__mips16_", 9) == 0)
7737 return 0;
7739 /* This code will only work for o32 and o64 abis. The other ABI's
7740 require more sophisticated support. */
7741 if (mips_abi != ABI_32 && mips_abi != ABI_O64)
7742 abort ();
7744 /* We can only handle SFmode and DFmode floating point return
7745 values. */
7746 if (fpret && GET_MODE (retval) != SFmode && GET_MODE (retval) != DFmode)
7747 abort ();
7749 /* If we're calling via a function pointer, then we must always call
7750 via a stub. There are magic stubs provided in libgcc.a for each
7751 of the required cases. Each of them expects the function address
7752 to arrive in register $2. */
7754 if (GET_CODE (fn) != SYMBOL_REF)
7756 char buf[30];
7757 tree id;
7758 rtx stub_fn, insn;
7760 /* ??? If this code is modified to support other ABI's, we need
7761 to handle PARALLEL return values here. */
7763 sprintf (buf, "__mips16_call_stub_%s%d",
7764 (fpret
7765 ? (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode ? "sf_" : "df_")
7766 : ""),
7767 fp_code);
7768 id = get_identifier (buf);
7769 stub_fn = gen_rtx (SYMBOL_REF, Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (id));
7771 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, 2), fn);
7773 if (retval == NULL_RTX)
7774 insn = gen_call_internal (stub_fn, arg_size);
7775 else
7776 insn = gen_call_value_internal (retval, stub_fn, arg_size);
7777 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
7779 /* Put the register usage information on the CALL. */
7780 if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL_INSN)
7781 abort ();
7782 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7783 gen_rtx (EXPR_LIST, VOIDmode,
7784 gen_rtx (USE, VOIDmode, gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, 2)),
7785 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7787 /* If we are handling a floating point return value, we need to
7788 save $18 in the function prologue. Putting a note on the
7789 call will mean that regs_ever_live[$18] will be true if the
7790 call is not eliminated, and we can check that in the prologue
7791 code. */
7792 if (fpret)
7793 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7794 gen_rtx (EXPR_LIST, VOIDmode,
7795 gen_rtx (USE, VOIDmode, gen_rtx (REG, word_mode, 18)),
7796 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7798 /* Return 1 to tell the caller that we've generated the call
7799 insn. */
7800 return 1;
7803 /* We know the function we are going to call. If we have already
7804 built a stub, we don't need to do anything further. */
7806 fnname = XSTR (fn, 0);
7807 for (l = mips16_stubs; l != NULL; l = l->next)
7808 if (strcmp (l->name, fnname) == 0)
7809 break;
7811 if (l == NULL)
7813 /* Build a special purpose stub. When the linker sees a
7814 function call in mips16 code, it will check where the target
7815 is defined. If the target is a 32 bit call, the linker will
7816 search for the section defined here. It can tell which
7817 symbol this section is associated with by looking at the
7818 relocation information (the name is unreliable, since this
7819 might be a static function). If such a section is found, the
7820 linker will redirect the call to the start of the magic
7821 section.
7823 If the function does not return a floating point value, the
7824 special stub section is named
7825 .mips16.call.FNNAME
7827 If the function does return a floating point value, the stub
7828 section is named
7829 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME
7832 secname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 40);
7833 sprintf (secname, ".mips16.call.%s%s",
7834 fpret ? "fp." : "",
7835 fnname);
7836 stubname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7837 sprintf (stubname, "__call_stub_%s%s",
7838 fpret ? "fp_" : "",
7839 fnname);
7840 stubid = get_identifier (stubname);
7841 stubdecl = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, stubid,
7842 build_function_type (void_type_node, NULL_TREE));
7843 DECL_SECTION_NAME (stubdecl) = build_string (strlen (secname), secname);
7845 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t# Stub function to call %s%s (",
7846 (fpret
7847 ? (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode ? "float " : "double ")
7848 : ""),
7849 fnname);
7850 need_comma = 0;
7851 for (f = (unsigned int) fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7853 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s%s",
7854 need_comma ? ", " : "",
7855 (f & 3) == 1 ? "float" : "double");
7856 need_comma = 1;
7858 fprintf (asm_out_file, ")\n");
7860 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnomips16\n");
7861 assemble_start_function (stubdecl, stubname);
7863 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7865 fputs ("\t.ent\t", asm_out_file);
7866 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7867 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
7869 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7870 fputs (":\n", asm_out_file);
7873 /* We build the stub code by hand. That's the only way we can
7874 do it, since we can't generate 32 bit code during a 16 bit
7875 compilation. */
7877 /* We don't want the assembler to insert any nops here. */
7878 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoreorder\n");
7880 mips16_fp_args (asm_out_file, fp_code, 0);
7882 if (! fpret)
7884 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoat\n");
7885 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tla\t%s,%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1],
7886 fnname);
7887 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjr\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7888 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tat\n");
7889 /* Unfortunately, we can't fill the jump delay slot. We
7890 can't fill with one of the mtc1 instructions, because the
7891 result is not available for one instruction, so if the
7892 very first instruction in the function refers to the
7893 register, it will see the wrong value. */
7894 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7896 else
7898 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmove\t%s,%s\n",
7899 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 18], reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 31]);
7900 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjal\t%s\n", fnname);
7901 /* As above, we can't fill the delay slot. */
7902 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7903 if (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode)
7904 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7905 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2], reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7906 else
7908 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
7910 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7911 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2],
7912 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7913 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7914 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 3],
7915 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7917 else
7919 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7920 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2],
7921 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7922 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7923 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 3],
7924 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7927 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tj\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 18]);
7928 /* As above, we can't fill the delay slot. */
7929 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7932 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\treorder\n");
7934 #ifdef ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
7935 ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (asm_out_file, stubname, stubdecl);
7936 #endif
7938 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7940 fputs ("\t.end\t", asm_out_file);
7941 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7942 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
7945 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
7947 /* Record this stub. */
7948 l = (struct mips16_stub *) xmalloc (sizeof *l);
7949 l->name = xstrdup (fnname);
7950 l->fpret = fpret;
7951 l->next = mips16_stubs;
7952 mips16_stubs = l;
7955 /* If we expect a floating point return value, but we've built a
7956 stub which does not expect one, then we're in trouble. We can't
7957 use the existing stub, because it won't handle the floating point
7958 value. We can't build a new stub, because the linker won't know
7959 which stub to use for the various calls in this object file.
7960 Fortunately, this case is illegal, since it means that a function
7961 was declared in two different ways in a single compilation. */
7962 if (fpret && ! l->fpret)
7963 error ("can not handle inconsistent calls to `%s'", fnname);
7965 /* If we are calling a stub which handles a floating point return
7966 value, we need to arrange to save $18 in the prologue. We do
7967 this by marking the function call as using the register. The
7968 prologue will later see that it is used, and emit code to save
7969 it. */
7971 if (l->fpret)
7973 rtx insn;
7975 if (retval == NULL_RTX)
7976 insn = gen_call_internal (fn, arg_size);
7977 else
7978 insn = gen_call_value_internal (retval, fn, arg_size);
7979 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
7981 if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL_INSN)
7982 abort ();
7984 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7985 gen_rtx (EXPR_LIST, VOIDmode,
7986 gen_rtx (USE, VOIDmode, gen_rtx (REG, word_mode, 18)),
7987 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7989 /* Return 1 to tell the caller that we've generated the call
7990 insn. */
7991 return 1;
7994 /* Return 0 to let the caller generate the call insn. */
7995 return 0;
7998 /* This function looks through the code for a function, and tries to
7999 optimize the usage of the $gp register. We arrange to copy $gp
8000 into a pseudo-register, and then let gcc's normal reload handling
8001 deal with the pseudo-register. Unfortunately, if reload choose to
8002 put the pseudo-register into a call-clobbered register, it will
8003 emit saves and restores for that register around any function
8004 calls. We don't need the saves, and it's faster to copy $gp than
8005 to do an actual restore. ??? This still means that we waste a
8006 stack slot.
8008 This is an optimization, and the code which gcc has actually
8009 generated is correct, so we do not need to catch all cases. */
8011 static void
8012 mips16_optimize_gp (void)
8014 rtx gpcopy, slot, insn;
8016 /* Look through the instructions. Set GPCOPY to the register which
8017 holds a copy of $gp. Set SLOT to the stack slot where it is
8018 saved. If we find an instruction which sets GPCOPY to anything
8019 other than $gp or SLOT, then we can't use it. If we find an
8020 instruction which sets SLOT to anything other than GPCOPY, we
8021 can't use it. */
8023 gpcopy = NULL_RTX;
8024 slot = NULL_RTX;
8025 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != NULL_RTX; insn = next_active_insn (insn))
8027 rtx set;
8029 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8030 continue;
8032 set = PATTERN (insn);
8034 /* We know that all references to memory will be inside a SET,
8035 because there is no other way to access memory on the mips16.
8036 We don't have to worry about a PARALLEL here, because the
8037 mips.md file will never generate them for memory references. */
8038 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
8039 continue;
8041 if (gpcopy == NULL_RTX
8042 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == CONST
8043 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
8044 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG)
8045 gpcopy = SET_DEST (set);
8046 else if (slot == NULL_RTX
8047 && gpcopy != NULL_RTX
8048 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
8049 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
8050 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) == REGNO (gpcopy))
8052 rtx base, offset;
8054 offset = const0_rtx;
8055 base = eliminate_constant_term (XEXP (SET_DEST (set), 0), &offset);
8056 if (GET_CODE (base) == REG
8057 && (REGNO (base) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
8058 || REGNO (base) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM))
8059 slot = SET_DEST (set);
8061 else if (gpcopy != NULL_RTX
8062 && (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
8063 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == SUBREG)
8064 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (set), gpcopy)
8065 && (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) != REG
8066 || REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) != REGNO (gpcopy)
8067 || ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != CONST
8068 || XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) != pic_offset_table_rtx)
8069 && ! rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), slot))))
8070 break;
8071 else if (slot != NULL_RTX
8072 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
8073 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set), slot)
8074 && (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != REG
8075 || REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) != REGNO (gpcopy)))
8076 break;
8079 /* If we couldn't find a unique value for GPCOPY or SLOT, then try a
8080 different optimization. Any time we find a copy of $28 into a
8081 register, followed by an add of a symbol_ref to that register, we
8082 convert it to load the value from the constant table instead.
8083 The copy and add will take six bytes, just as the load and
8084 constant table entry will take six bytes. However, it is
8085 possible that the constant table entry will be shared.
8087 This could be a peephole optimization, but I don't know if the
8088 peephole code can call force_const_mem.
8090 Using the same register for the copy of $28 and the add of the
8091 symbol_ref is actually pretty likely, since the add instruction
8092 requires the destination and the first addend to be the same
8093 register. */
8095 if (insn != NULL_RTX || gpcopy == NULL_RTX || slot == NULL_RTX)
8097 #if 0
8098 /* Used below in #if 0 area. */
8099 rtx next;
8100 #endif
8101 /* This optimization is only reasonable if the constant table
8102 entries are only 4 bytes. */
8103 if (Pmode != SImode)
8104 return;
8106 #if 0
8107 /* ??? FIXME. Rewrite for new UNSPEC_RELOC stuff. */
8108 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != NULL_RTX; insn = next)
8110 rtx set1, set2;
8112 next = insn;
8115 next = NEXT_INSN (next);
8117 while (next != NULL_RTX
8118 && (GET_CODE (next) == NOTE
8119 || (GET_CODE (next) == INSN
8120 && (GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == USE
8121 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == CLOBBER))));
8123 if (next == NULL_RTX)
8124 break;
8126 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8127 continue;
8129 if (! INSN_P (next))
8130 continue;
8132 set1 = PATTERN (insn);
8133 if (GET_CODE (set1) != SET)
8134 continue;
8135 set2 = PATTERN (next);
8136 if (GET_CODE (set2) != SET)
8137 continue;
8139 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set1)) == REG
8140 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set1)) == CONST
8141 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set1), 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
8142 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set1), SET_DEST (set2))
8143 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) == PLUS
8144 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set1), XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
8145 && mips16_gp_offset_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))
8146 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1), 0)) == MINUS)
8148 rtx sym;
8150 /* We've found a case we can change to load from the
8151 constant table. */
8153 sym = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1), 0), 0);
8154 if (GET_CODE (sym) != SYMBOL_REF)
8155 abort ();
8156 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx (SET, VOIDmode, SET_DEST (set1),
8157 force_const_mem (Pmode, sym)),
8158 next);
8160 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8161 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8162 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8164 PUT_CODE (next, NOTE);
8165 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (next) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8166 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (next) = 0;
8169 #endif
8171 return;
8173 /* We can safely remove all assignments to SLOT from GPCOPY, and
8174 replace all assignments from SLOT to GPCOPY with assignments from
8175 $28. */
8177 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != NULL_RTX; insn = next_active_insn (insn))
8179 rtx set;
8181 if (! INSN_P (insn))
8182 continue;
8184 set = PATTERN (insn);
8185 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
8186 continue;
8188 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
8189 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set), slot)
8190 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
8191 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) == REGNO (gpcopy))
8193 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8194 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8195 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8197 else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
8198 && REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) == REGNO (gpcopy)
8199 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == MEM
8200 && rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), slot))
8202 enum machine_mode mode;
8203 rtx src;
8205 mode = GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set));
8206 src = gen_rtx_CONST (mode, pic_offset_table_rtx);
8207 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, SET_DEST (set), src), insn);
8208 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
8209 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
8210 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
8215 /* We keep a list of constants we which we have to add to internal
8216 constant tables in the middle of large functions. */
8218 struct constant
8220 struct constant *next;
8221 rtx value;
8222 rtx label;
8223 enum machine_mode mode;
8226 /* Add a constant to the list in *PCONSTANTS. */
8228 static rtx
8229 add_constant (struct constant **pconstants, rtx val, enum machine_mode mode)
8231 struct constant *c;
8233 for (c = *pconstants; c != NULL; c = c->next)
8234 if (mode == c->mode && rtx_equal_p (val, c->value))
8235 return c->label;
8237 c = (struct constant *) xmalloc (sizeof *c);
8238 c->value = val;
8239 c->mode = mode;
8240 c->label = gen_label_rtx ();
8241 c->next = *pconstants;
8242 *pconstants = c;
8243 return c->label;
8246 /* Dump out the constants in CONSTANTS after INSN. */
8248 static void
8249 dump_constants (struct constant *constants, rtx insn)
8251 struct constant *c;
8252 int align;
8254 c = constants;
8255 align = 0;
8256 while (c != NULL)
8258 rtx r;
8259 struct constant *next;
8261 switch (GET_MODE_SIZE (c->mode))
8263 case 1:
8264 align = 0;
8265 break;
8266 case 2:
8267 if (align < 1)
8268 insn = emit_insn_after (gen_align_2 (), insn);
8269 align = 1;
8270 break;
8271 case 4:
8272 if (align < 2)
8273 insn = emit_insn_after (gen_align_4 (), insn);
8274 align = 2;
8275 break;
8276 default:
8277 if (align < 3)
8278 insn = emit_insn_after (gen_align_8 (), insn);
8279 align = 3;
8280 break;
8283 insn = emit_label_after (c->label, insn);
8285 switch (c->mode)
8287 case QImode:
8288 r = gen_consttable_qi (c->value);
8289 break;
8290 case HImode:
8291 r = gen_consttable_hi (c->value);
8292 break;
8293 case SImode:
8294 r = gen_consttable_si (c->value);
8295 break;
8296 case SFmode:
8297 r = gen_consttable_sf (c->value);
8298 break;
8299 case DImode:
8300 r = gen_consttable_di (c->value);
8301 break;
8302 case DFmode:
8303 r = gen_consttable_df (c->value);
8304 break;
8305 default:
8306 abort ();
8309 insn = emit_insn_after (r, insn);
8311 next = c->next;
8312 free (c);
8313 c = next;
8316 emit_barrier_after (insn);
8319 /* Find the symbol in an address expression. */
8321 static rtx
8322 mips_find_symbol (rtx addr)
8324 if (GET_CODE (addr) == MEM)
8325 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
8326 while (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST)
8327 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
8328 if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (addr) == LABEL_REF)
8329 return addr;
8330 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
8332 rtx l1, l2;
8334 l1 = mips_find_symbol (XEXP (addr, 0));
8335 l2 = mips_find_symbol (XEXP (addr, 1));
8336 if (l1 != NULL_RTX && l2 == NULL_RTX)
8337 return l1;
8338 else if (l1 == NULL_RTX && l2 != NULL_RTX)
8339 return l2;
8341 return NULL_RTX;
8344 /* In mips16 mode, we need to look through the function to check for
8345 PC relative loads that are out of range. */
8347 static void
8348 mips16_lay_out_constants (void)
8350 int insns_len, max_internal_pool_size, pool_size, addr, first_constant_ref;
8351 rtx first, insn;
8352 struct constant *constants;
8354 first = get_insns ();
8356 /* Scan the function looking for PC relative loads which may be out
8357 of range. All such loads will either be from the constant table,
8358 or be getting the address of a constant string. If the size of
8359 the function plus the size of the constant table is less than
8360 0x8000, then all loads are in range. */
8362 insns_len = 0;
8363 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8365 insns_len += get_attr_length (insn);
8367 /* ??? We put switch tables in .text, but we don't define
8368 JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION, so get_attr_length will not
8369 compute their lengths correctly. */
8370 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
8372 rtx body;
8374 body = PATTERN (insn);
8375 if (GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_VEC || GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
8376 insns_len += (XVECLEN (body, GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
8377 * GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)));
8378 insns_len += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)) - 1;
8382 /* Store the original value of insns_len in cfun->machine, so
8383 that simple_memory_operand can look at it. */
8384 cfun->machine->insns_len = insns_len;
8386 pool_size = get_pool_size ();
8387 if (insns_len + pool_size + mips_string_length < 0x8000)
8388 return;
8390 /* Loop over the insns and figure out what the maximum internal pool
8391 size could be. */
8392 max_internal_pool_size = 0;
8393 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8395 if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
8396 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
8398 rtx src;
8400 src = mips_find_symbol (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)));
8401 if (src == NULL_RTX)
8402 continue;
8403 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (src))
8404 max_internal_pool_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (src));
8405 else if (SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (src))
8406 max_internal_pool_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
8410 constants = NULL;
8411 addr = 0;
8412 first_constant_ref = -1;
8414 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8416 if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
8417 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
8419 rtx val, src;
8420 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
8422 val = NULL_RTX;
8423 src = mips_find_symbol (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)));
8424 if (src != NULL_RTX && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (src))
8426 /* ??? This is very conservative, which means that we
8427 will generate too many copies of the constant table.
8428 The only solution would seem to be some form of
8429 relaxing. */
8430 if (((insns_len - addr)
8431 + max_internal_pool_size
8432 + get_pool_offset (src))
8433 >= 0x8000)
8435 val = get_pool_constant (src);
8436 mode = get_pool_mode (src);
8438 max_internal_pool_size -= GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (src));
8440 else if (src != NULL_RTX && SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (src))
8442 /* Including all of mips_string_length is conservative,
8443 and so is including all of max_internal_pool_size. */
8444 if (((insns_len - addr)
8445 + max_internal_pool_size
8446 + pool_size
8447 + mips_string_length)
8448 >= 0x8000)
8450 val = src;
8451 mode = Pmode;
8453 max_internal_pool_size -= Pmode;
8456 if (val != NULL_RTX)
8458 rtx lab, newsrc;
8460 /* This PC relative load is out of range. ??? In the
8461 case of a string constant, we are only guessing that
8462 it is range, since we don't know the offset of a
8463 particular string constant. */
8465 lab = add_constant (&constants, val, mode);
8466 newsrc = gen_rtx (MEM, mode,
8467 gen_rtx (LABEL_REF, VOIDmode, lab));
8468 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (newsrc) = 1;
8469 PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx (SET, VOIDmode,
8470 SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)),
8471 newsrc);
8472 INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
8474 if (first_constant_ref < 0)
8475 first_constant_ref = addr;
8479 addr += get_attr_length (insn);
8481 /* ??? We put switch tables in .text, but we don't define
8482 JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION, so get_attr_length will not
8483 compute their lengths correctly. */
8484 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
8486 rtx body;
8488 body = PATTERN (insn);
8489 if (GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_VEC || GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
8490 addr += (XVECLEN (body, GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
8491 * GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)));
8492 addr += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)) - 1;
8495 if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
8497 /* Output any constants we have accumulated. Note that we
8498 don't need to change ADDR, since its only use is
8499 subtraction from INSNS_LEN, and both would be changed by
8500 the same amount.
8501 ??? If the instructions up to the next barrier reuse a
8502 constant, it would often be better to continue
8503 accumulating. */
8504 if (constants != NULL)
8505 dump_constants (constants, insn);
8506 constants = NULL;
8507 first_constant_ref = -1;
8510 if (constants != NULL
8511 && (NEXT_INSN (insn) == NULL
8512 || (first_constant_ref >= 0
8513 && (((addr - first_constant_ref)
8514 + 2 /* for alignment */
8515 + 2 /* for a short jump insn */
8516 + pool_size)
8517 >= 0x8000))))
8519 /* If we haven't had a barrier within 0x8000 bytes of a
8520 constant reference or we are at the end of the function,
8521 emit a barrier now. */
8523 rtx label, jump, barrier;
8525 label = gen_label_rtx ();
8526 jump = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_jump (label), insn);
8527 JUMP_LABEL (jump) = label;
8528 LABEL_NUSES (label) = 1;
8529 barrier = emit_barrier_after (jump);
8530 emit_label_after (label, barrier);
8531 first_constant_ref = -1;
8535 /* ??? If we output all references to a constant in internal
8536 constants table, we don't need to output the constant in the real
8537 constant table, but we have no way to prevent that. */
8541 /* Subroutine of mips_reorg. If there is a hazard between INSN
8542 and a previous instruction, avoid it by inserting nops after
8543 instruction AFTER.
8545 *DELAYED_REG and *HILO_DELAY describe the hazards that apply at
8546 this point. If *DELAYED_REG is non-null, INSN must wait a cycle
8547 before using the value of that register. *HILO_DELAY counts the
8548 number of instructions since the last hilo hazard (that is,
8549 the number of instructions since the last mflo or mfhi).
8551 After inserting nops for INSN, update *DELAYED_REG and *HILO_DELAY
8552 for the next instruction.
8554 LO_REG is an rtx for the LO register, used in dependence checking. */
8556 static void
8557 mips_avoid_hazard (rtx after, rtx insn, int *hilo_delay,
8558 rtx *delayed_reg, rtx lo_reg)
8560 rtx pattern, set;
8561 int nops, ninsns;
8563 if (!INSN_P (insn))
8564 return;
8566 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
8568 /* Do not put the whole function in .set noreorder if it contains
8569 an asm statement. We don't know whether there will be hazards
8570 between the asm statement and the gcc-generated code. */
8571 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == ASM_INPUT || asm_noperands (pattern) >= 0)
8572 cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p = false;
8574 /* Ignore zero-length instructions (barriers and the like). */
8575 ninsns = get_attr_length (insn) / 4;
8576 if (ninsns == 0)
8577 return;
8579 /* Work out how many nops are needed. Note that we only care about
8580 registers that are explicitly mentioned in the instruction's pattern.
8581 It doesn't matter that calls use the argument registers or that they
8582 clobber hi and lo. */
8583 if (*hilo_delay < 2 && reg_set_p (lo_reg, pattern))
8584 nops = 2 - *hilo_delay;
8585 else if (*delayed_reg != 0 && reg_referenced_p (*delayed_reg, pattern))
8586 nops = 1;
8587 else
8588 nops = 0;
8590 /* Insert the nops between this instruction and the previous one.
8591 Each new nop takes us further from the last hilo hazard. */
8592 *hilo_delay += nops;
8593 while (nops-- > 0)
8594 emit_insn_after (gen_hazard_nop (), after);
8596 /* Set up the state for the next instruction. */
8597 *hilo_delay += ninsns;
8598 *delayed_reg = 0;
8599 if (INSN_CODE (insn) >= 0)
8600 switch (get_attr_hazard (insn))
8602 case HAZARD_NONE:
8603 break;
8605 case HAZARD_HILO:
8606 *hilo_delay = 0;
8607 break;
8609 case HAZARD_DELAY:
8610 set = single_set (insn);
8611 if (set == 0)
8612 abort ();
8613 *delayed_reg = SET_DEST (set);
8614 break;
8619 /* Go through the instruction stream and insert nops where necessary.
8620 See if the whole function can then be put into .set noreorder &
8621 .set nomacro. */
8623 static void
8624 mips_avoid_hazards (void)
8626 rtx insn, last_insn, lo_reg, delayed_reg;
8627 int hilo_delay, i;
8629 /* Recalculate instruction lengths without taking nops into account. */
8630 cfun->machine->ignore_hazard_length_p = true;
8631 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8633 /* The profiler code uses assembler macros. */
8634 cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p = !current_function_profile;
8636 last_insn = 0;
8637 hilo_delay = 2;
8638 delayed_reg = 0;
8639 lo_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LO_REGNUM);
8641 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8642 if (INSN_P (insn))
8644 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
8645 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); i++)
8646 mips_avoid_hazard (last_insn, XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
8647 &hilo_delay, &delayed_reg, lo_reg);
8648 else
8649 mips_avoid_hazard (last_insn, insn, &hilo_delay,
8650 &delayed_reg, lo_reg);
8652 last_insn = insn;
8657 /* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. */
8659 static void
8660 mips_reorg (void)
8662 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8664 if (optimize)
8665 mips16_optimize_gp ();
8666 mips16_lay_out_constants ();
8668 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
8670 if (mips_flag_delayed_branch)
8671 dbr_schedule (get_insns (), rtl_dump_file);
8672 mips_avoid_hazards ();
8676 /* We need to use a special set of functions to handle hard floating
8677 point code in mips16 mode. Also, allow for --enable-gofast. */
8679 #include "config/gofast.h"
8681 static void
8682 mips_init_libfuncs (void)
8684 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && mips16_hard_float)
8686 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_addsf3");
8687 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_subsf3");
8688 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_mulsf3");
8689 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_divsf3");
8691 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_eqsf2");
8692 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_nesf2");
8693 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_gtsf2");
8694 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_gesf2");
8695 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_ltsf2");
8696 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_lesf2");
8698 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__mips16_fixsfsi");
8699 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__mips16_floatsisf");
8701 if (TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT)
8703 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_adddf3");
8704 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_subdf3");
8705 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_muldf3");
8706 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_divdf3");
8708 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_eqdf2");
8709 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_nedf2");
8710 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_gtdf2");
8711 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_gedf2");
8712 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_ltdf2");
8713 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_ledf2");
8715 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__mips16_extendsfdf2");
8716 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__mips16_truncdfsf2");
8718 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__mips16_fixdfsi");
8719 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__mips16_floatsidf");
8722 else
8723 gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs ();
8726 /* Return a number assessing the cost of moving a register in class
8727 FROM to class TO. The classes are expressed using the enumeration
8728 values such as `GENERAL_REGS'. A value of 2 is the default; other
8729 values are interpreted relative to that.
8731 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when FROM is the
8732 same as TO; on some machines it is expensive to move between
8733 registers if they are not general registers.
8735 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single `set' between two
8736 hard registers, and if `REGISTER_MOVE_COST' applied to their
8737 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that
8738 the constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than
8739 2 will allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You
8740 should do this if the `movM' pattern's constraints do not allow
8741 such copying.
8743 ??? We make the cost of moving from HI/LO into general
8744 registers the same as for one of moving general registers to
8745 HI/LO for TARGET_MIPS16 in order to prevent allocating a
8746 pseudo to HI/LO. This might hurt optimizations though, it
8747 isn't clear if it is wise. And it might not work in all cases. We
8748 could solve the DImode LO reg problem by using a multiply, just
8749 like reload_{in,out}si. We could solve the SImode/HImode HI reg
8750 problem by using divide instructions. divu puts the remainder in
8751 the HI reg, so doing a divide by -1 will move the value in the HI
8752 reg for all values except -1. We could handle that case by using a
8753 signed divide, e.g. -1 / 2 (or maybe 1 / -2?). We'd have to emit
8754 a compare/branch to test the input value to see which instruction
8755 we need to use. This gets pretty messy, but it is feasible. */
8758 mips_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8759 enum reg_class to, enum reg_class from)
8761 if (from == M16_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8762 return 2;
8763 else if (from == M16_NA_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8764 return 2;
8765 else if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (from))
8767 if (to == M16_REGS)
8768 return 2;
8769 else if (to == M16_NA_REGS)
8770 return 2;
8771 else if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8773 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8774 return 4;
8775 else
8776 return 2;
8778 else if (to == FP_REGS)
8779 return 4;
8780 else if (to == HI_REG || to == LO_REG || to == MD_REGS)
8782 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8783 return 12;
8784 else
8785 return 6;
8787 else if (COP_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8789 return 5;
8791 } /* GR_REG_CLASS_P (from) */
8792 else if (from == FP_REGS)
8794 if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8795 return 4;
8796 else if (to == FP_REGS)
8797 return 2;
8798 else if (to == ST_REGS)
8799 return 8;
8800 } /* from == FP_REGS */
8801 else if (from == HI_REG || from == LO_REG || from == MD_REGS)
8803 if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8805 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8806 return 12;
8807 else
8808 return 6;
8810 } /* from == HI_REG, etc. */
8811 else if (from == ST_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8812 return 4;
8813 else if (COP_REG_CLASS_P (from))
8815 return 5;
8816 } /* COP_REG_CLASS_P (from) */
8818 /* fallthru */
8820 return 12;
8823 /* Return the length of INSN. LENGTH is the initial length computed by
8824 attributes in the machine-description file. */
8827 mips_adjust_insn_length (rtx insn, int length)
8829 /* A unconditional jump has an unfilled delay slot if it is not part
8830 of a sequence. A conditional jump normally has a delay slot, but
8831 does not on MIPS16. */
8832 if (simplejump_p (insn)
8833 || (!TARGET_MIPS16 && (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
8834 || GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)))
8835 length += 4;
8837 /* See how many nops might be needed to avoid hardware hazards. */
8838 if (!cfun->machine->ignore_hazard_length_p && INSN_CODE (insn) >= 0)
8839 switch (get_attr_hazard (insn))
8841 case HAZARD_NONE:
8842 break;
8844 case HAZARD_DELAY:
8845 length += 4;
8846 break;
8848 case HAZARD_HILO:
8849 length += 8;
8850 break;
8853 /* All MIPS16 instructions are a measly two bytes. */
8854 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8855 length /= 2;
8857 return length;
8861 /* Return an asm sequence to start a noat block and load the address
8862 of a label into $1. */
8864 const char *
8865 mips_output_load_label (void)
8867 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
8868 switch (mips_abi)
8870 case ABI_N32:
8871 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got_page(%0)(%+)\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%got_ofst(%0)";
8873 case ABI_64:
8874 return "%[ld\t%@,%%got_page(%0)(%+)\n\tdaddiu\t%@,%@,%%got_ofst(%0)";
8876 default:
8877 if (ISA_HAS_LOAD_DELAY)
8878 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got(%0)(%+)%#\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%lo(%0)";
8879 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got(%0)(%+)\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%lo(%0)";
8881 else
8883 if (Pmode == DImode)
8884 return "%[dla\t%@,%0";
8885 else
8886 return "%[la\t%@,%0";
8891 /* Output assembly instructions to peform a conditional branch.
8893 INSN is the branch instruction. OPERANDS[0] is the condition.
8894 OPERANDS[1] is the target of the branch. OPERANDS[2] is the target
8895 of the first operand to the condition. If TWO_OPERANDS_P is
8896 nonzero the comparison takes two operands; OPERANDS[3] will be the
8897 second operand.
8899 If INVERTED_P is nonzero we are to branch if the condition does
8900 not hold. If FLOAT_P is nonzero this is a floating-point comparison.
8902 LENGTH is the length (in bytes) of the sequence we are to generate.
8903 That tells us whether to generate a simple conditional branch, or a
8904 reversed conditional branch around a `jr' instruction. */
8905 const char *
8906 mips_output_conditional_branch (rtx insn, rtx *operands, int two_operands_p,
8907 int float_p, int inverted_p, int length)
8909 static char buffer[200];
8910 /* The kind of comparison we are doing. */
8911 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
8912 /* Nonzero if the opcode for the comparison needs a `z' indicating
8913 that it is a comparison against zero. */
8914 int need_z_p;
8915 /* A string to use in the assembly output to represent the first
8916 operand. */
8917 const char *op1 = "%z2";
8918 /* A string to use in the assembly output to represent the second
8919 operand. Use the hard-wired zero register if there's no second
8920 operand. */
8921 const char *op2 = (two_operands_p ? ",%z3" : ",%.");
8922 /* The operand-printing string for the comparison. */
8923 const char *const comp = (float_p ? "%F0" : "%C0");
8924 /* The operand-printing string for the inverted comparison. */
8925 const char *const inverted_comp = (float_p ? "%W0" : "%N0");
8927 /* The MIPS processors (for levels of the ISA at least two), have
8928 "likely" variants of each branch instruction. These instructions
8929 annul the instruction in the delay slot if the branch is not
8930 taken. */
8931 mips_branch_likely = (final_sequence && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn));
8933 if (!two_operands_p)
8935 /* To compute whether than A > B, for example, we normally
8936 subtract B from A and then look at the sign bit. But, if we
8937 are doing an unsigned comparison, and B is zero, we don't
8938 have to do the subtraction. Instead, we can just check to
8939 see if A is nonzero. Thus, we change the CODE here to
8940 reflect the simpler comparison operation. */
8941 switch (code)
8943 case GTU:
8944 code = NE;
8945 break;
8947 case LEU:
8948 code = EQ;
8949 break;
8951 case GEU:
8952 /* A condition which will always be true. */
8953 code = EQ;
8954 op1 = "%.";
8955 break;
8957 case LTU:
8958 /* A condition which will always be false. */
8959 code = NE;
8960 op1 = "%.";
8961 break;
8963 default:
8964 /* Not a special case. */
8965 break;
8969 /* Relative comparisons are always done against zero. But
8970 equality comparisons are done between two operands, and therefore
8971 do not require a `z' in the assembly language output. */
8972 need_z_p = (!float_p && code != EQ && code != NE);
8973 /* For comparisons against zero, the zero is not provided
8974 explicitly. */
8975 if (need_z_p)
8976 op2 = "";
8978 /* Begin by terminating the buffer. That way we can always use
8979 strcat to add to it. */
8980 buffer[0] = '\0';
8982 switch (length)
8984 case 4:
8985 case 8:
8986 /* Just a simple conditional branch. */
8987 if (float_p)
8988 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%%?\t%%Z2%%1%%/",
8989 inverted_p ? inverted_comp : comp);
8990 else
8991 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%s%%?\t%s%s,%%1%%/",
8992 inverted_p ? inverted_comp : comp,
8993 need_z_p ? "z" : "",
8994 op1,
8995 op2);
8996 return buffer;
8998 case 12:
8999 case 16:
9000 case 24:
9001 case 28:
9003 /* Generate a reversed conditional branch around ` j'
9004 instruction:
9006 .set noreorder
9007 .set nomacro
9008 bc l
9009 delay_slot or #nop
9010 j target
9011 #nop
9013 .set macro
9014 .set reorder
9016 If the original branch was a likely branch, the delay slot
9017 must be executed only if the branch is taken, so generate:
9019 .set noreorder
9020 .set nomacro
9021 bc l
9022 #nop
9023 j target
9024 delay slot or #nop
9026 .set macro
9027 .set reorder
9029 When generating non-embedded PIC, instead of:
9031 j target
9033 we emit:
9035 .set noat
9036 la $at, target
9037 jr $at
9038 .set at
9041 rtx orig_target;
9042 rtx target = gen_label_rtx ();
9044 orig_target = operands[1];
9045 operands[1] = target;
9046 /* Generate the reversed comparison. This takes four
9047 bytes. */
9048 if (float_p)
9049 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s\t%%Z2%%1",
9050 inverted_p ? comp : inverted_comp);
9051 else
9052 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%s\t%s%s,%%1",
9053 inverted_p ? comp : inverted_comp,
9054 need_z_p ? "z" : "",
9055 op1,
9056 op2);
9057 output_asm_insn (buffer, operands);
9059 if (length != 16 && length != 28 && ! mips_branch_likely)
9061 /* Output delay slot instruction. */
9062 rtx insn = final_sequence;
9063 final_scan_insn (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1), asm_out_file,
9064 optimize, 0, 1);
9065 INSN_DELETED_P (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1)) = 1;
9067 else
9068 output_asm_insn ("%#", 0);
9070 if (length <= 16)
9071 output_asm_insn ("j\t%0", &orig_target);
9072 else
9074 output_asm_insn (mips_output_load_label (), &orig_target);
9075 output_asm_insn ("jr\t%@%]", 0);
9078 if (length != 16 && length != 28 && mips_branch_likely)
9080 /* Output delay slot instruction. */
9081 rtx insn = final_sequence;
9082 final_scan_insn (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1), asm_out_file,
9083 optimize, 0, 1);
9084 INSN_DELETED_P (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1)) = 1;
9086 else
9087 output_asm_insn ("%#", 0);
9089 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "L",
9090 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (target));
9092 return "";
9095 default:
9096 abort ();
9099 /* NOTREACHED */
9100 return 0;
9103 /* Used to output div or ddiv instruction DIVISION, which has the
9104 operands given by OPERANDS. If we need a divide-by-zero check,
9105 output the instruction and return an asm string that traps if
9106 operand 2 is zero. Otherwise just return DIVISION itself. */
9108 const char *
9109 mips_output_division (const char *division, rtx *operands)
9111 if (TARGET_CHECK_ZERO_DIV)
9113 output_asm_insn (division, operands);
9115 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
9116 return "bnez\t%2,1f\n\tbreak\t7\n1:";
9117 else
9118 return "bne\t%2,%.,1f%#\n\tbreak\t7\n1:";
9120 return division;
9123 /* Return true if GIVEN is the same as CANONICAL, or if it is CANONICAL
9124 with a final "000" replaced by "k". Ignore case.
9126 Note: this function is shared between GCC and GAS. */
9128 static bool
9129 mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *canonical, const char *given)
9131 while (*given != 0 && TOLOWER (*given) == TOLOWER (*canonical))
9132 given++, canonical++;
9134 return ((*given == 0 && *canonical == 0)
9135 || (strcmp (canonical, "000") == 0 && strcasecmp (given, "k") == 0));
9139 /* Return true if GIVEN matches CANONICAL, where GIVEN is a user-supplied
9140 CPU name. We've traditionally allowed a lot of variation here.
9142 Note: this function is shared between GCC and GAS. */
9144 static bool
9145 mips_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *canonical, const char *given)
9147 /* First see if the name matches exactly, or with a final "000"
9148 turned into "k". */
9149 if (mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (canonical, given))
9150 return true;
9152 /* If not, try comparing based on numerical designation alone.
9153 See if GIVEN is an unadorned number, or 'r' followed by a number. */
9154 if (TOLOWER (*given) == 'r')
9155 given++;
9156 if (!ISDIGIT (*given))
9157 return false;
9159 /* Skip over some well-known prefixes in the canonical name,
9160 hoping to find a number there too. */
9161 if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'v' && TOLOWER (canonical[1]) == 'r')
9162 canonical += 2;
9163 else if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'r' && TOLOWER (canonical[1]) == 'm')
9164 canonical += 2;
9165 else if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'r')
9166 canonical += 1;
9168 return mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (canonical, given);
9172 /* Parse an option that takes the name of a processor as its argument.
9173 OPTION is the name of the option and CPU_STRING is the argument.
9174 Return the corresponding processor enumeration if the CPU_STRING is
9175 recognized, otherwise report an error and return null.
9177 A similar function exists in GAS. */
9179 static const struct mips_cpu_info *
9180 mips_parse_cpu (const char *option, const char *cpu_string)
9182 const struct mips_cpu_info *p;
9183 const char *s;
9185 /* In the past, we allowed upper-case CPU names, but it doesn't
9186 work well with the multilib machinery. */
9187 for (s = cpu_string; *s != 0; s++)
9188 if (ISUPPER (*s))
9190 warning ("the cpu name must be lower case");
9191 break;
9194 /* 'from-abi' selects the most compatible architecture for the given
9195 ABI: MIPS I for 32-bit ABIs and MIPS III for 64-bit ABIs. For the
9196 EABIs, we have to decide whether we're using the 32-bit or 64-bit
9197 version. Look first at the -mgp options, if given, otherwise base
9198 the choice on MASK_64BIT in TARGET_DEFAULT. */
9199 if (strcasecmp (cpu_string, "from-abi") == 0)
9200 return mips_cpu_info_from_isa (ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS ? 1
9201 : ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS ? 3
9202 : (TARGET_64BIT ? 3 : 1));
9204 /* 'default' has traditionally been a no-op. Probably not very useful. */
9205 if (strcasecmp (cpu_string, "default") == 0)
9206 return 0;
9208 for (p = mips_cpu_info_table; p->name != 0; p++)
9209 if (mips_matching_cpu_name_p (p->name, cpu_string))
9210 return p;
9212 error ("bad value (%s) for %s", cpu_string, option);
9213 return 0;
9217 /* Return the processor associated with the given ISA level, or null
9218 if the ISA isn't valid. */
9220 static const struct mips_cpu_info *
9221 mips_cpu_info_from_isa (int isa)
9223 const struct mips_cpu_info *p;
9225 for (p = mips_cpu_info_table; p->name != 0; p++)
9226 if (p->isa == isa)
9227 return p;
9229 return 0;
9232 /* Adjust the cost of INSN based on the relationship between INSN that
9233 is dependent on DEP_INSN through the dependence LINK. The default
9234 is to make no adjustment to COST.
9236 On the MIPS, ignore the cost of anti- and output-dependencies. */
9237 static int
9238 mips_adjust_cost (rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx link,
9239 rtx dep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int cost)
9241 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0)
9242 return 0; /* Anti or output dependence. */
9243 return cost;
9246 /* Implement HARD_REGNO_NREGS. The size of FP registers are controlled
9247 by UNITS_PER_FPREG. All other registers are word sized. */
9249 unsigned int
9250 mips_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
9252 if (! FP_REG_P (regno))
9253 return ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD);
9254 else
9255 return ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_FPREG - 1) / UNITS_PER_FPREG);
9258 /* Implement RETURN_IN_MEMORY. Under the old (i.e., 32 and O64 ABIs)
9259 all BLKmode objects are returned in memory. Under the new (N32 and
9260 64-bit MIPS ABIs) small structures are returned in a register.
9261 Objects with varying size must still be returned in memory, of
9262 course. */
9265 mips_return_in_memory (tree type)
9267 if (mips_abi == ABI_32 || mips_abi == ABI_O64)
9268 return (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode);
9269 else
9270 return ((int_size_in_bytes (type) > (2 * UNITS_PER_WORD))
9271 || (int_size_in_bytes (type) == -1));
9274 static int
9275 mips_issue_rate (void)
9277 switch (mips_tune)
9279 case PROCESSOR_R5400:
9280 case PROCESSOR_R5500:
9281 case PROCESSOR_R7000:
9282 case PROCESSOR_R9000:
9283 return 2;
9285 default:
9286 return 1;
9289 abort ();
9293 /* Implements TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE. Return true for
9294 processors that have a DFA pipeline description. */
9296 static int
9297 mips_use_dfa_pipeline_interface (void)
9299 switch (mips_tune)
9301 case PROCESSOR_R5400:
9302 case PROCESSOR_R5500:
9303 case PROCESSOR_R7000:
9304 case PROCESSOR_R9000:
9305 case PROCESSOR_SR71000:
9306 return true;
9308 default:
9309 return false;
9314 const char *
9315 mips_emit_prefetch (rtx *operands)
9317 int write = INTVAL (operands[1]);
9318 int locality = INTVAL (operands[2]);
9319 int indexed = GET_CODE (operands[3]) == REG;
9320 int code;
9321 char buffer[30];
9323 if (locality <= 0)
9324 code = (write ? 5 : 4); /* store_streamed / load_streamed. */
9325 else if (locality <= 2)
9326 code = (write ? 1 : 0); /* store / load. */
9327 else
9328 code = (write ? 7 : 6); /* store_retained / load_retained. */
9330 sprintf (buffer, "%s\t%d,%%3(%%0)", indexed ? "prefx" : "pref", code);
9331 output_asm_insn (buffer, operands);
9332 return "";
9337 #if TARGET_IRIX
9338 /* Output assembly to switch to section NAME with attribute FLAGS. */
9340 static void
9341 irix_asm_named_section_1 (const char *name, unsigned int flags,
9342 unsigned int align)
9344 unsigned int sh_type, sh_flags, sh_entsize;
9346 sh_flags = 0;
9347 if (!(flags & SECTION_DEBUG))
9348 sh_flags |= 2; /* SHF_ALLOC */
9349 if (flags & SECTION_WRITE)
9350 sh_flags |= 1; /* SHF_WRITE */
9351 if (flags & SECTION_CODE)
9352 sh_flags |= 4; /* SHF_EXECINSTR */
9353 if (flags & SECTION_SMALL)
9354 sh_flags |= 0x10000000; /* SHF_MIPS_GPREL */
9355 if (strcmp (name, ".debug_frame") == 0)
9356 sh_flags |= 0x08000000; /* SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP */
9357 if (flags & SECTION_DEBUG)
9358 sh_type = 0x7000001e; /* SHT_MIPS_DWARF */
9359 else if (flags & SECTION_BSS)
9360 sh_type = 8; /* SHT_NOBITS */
9361 else
9362 sh_type = 1; /* SHT_PROGBITS */
9364 if (flags & SECTION_CODE)
9365 sh_entsize = 4;
9366 else
9367 sh_entsize = 0;
9369 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.section %s,%#x,%#x,%u,%u\n",
9370 name, sh_type, sh_flags, sh_entsize, align);
9373 static void
9374 irix_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags)
9376 if (TARGET_SGI_O32_AS)
9377 default_no_named_section (name, flags);
9378 else if (mips_abi == ABI_32 && TARGET_GAS)
9379 default_elf_asm_named_section (name, flags);
9380 else
9381 irix_asm_named_section_1 (name, flags, 0);
9384 /* In addition to emitting a .align directive, record the maximum
9385 alignment requested for the current section. */
9387 struct GTY (()) irix_section_align_entry
9389 const char *name;
9390 unsigned int log;
9391 unsigned int flags;
9394 static htab_t irix_section_align_htab;
9395 static FILE *irix_orig_asm_out_file;
9397 static int
9398 irix_section_align_entry_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
9400 const struct irix_section_align_entry *old = p1;
9401 const char *new = p2;
9403 return strcmp (old->name, new) == 0;
9406 static hashval_t
9407 irix_section_align_entry_hash (const void *p)
9409 const struct irix_section_align_entry *old = p;
9410 return htab_hash_string (old->name);
9413 void
9414 irix_asm_output_align (FILE *file, unsigned int log)
9416 const char *section = current_section_name ();
9417 struct irix_section_align_entry **slot, *entry;
9419 if (mips_abi != ABI_32)
9421 if (! section)
9422 abort ();
9424 slot = (struct irix_section_align_entry **)
9425 htab_find_slot_with_hash (irix_section_align_htab, section,
9426 htab_hash_string (section), INSERT);
9427 entry = *slot;
9428 if (! entry)
9430 entry = (struct irix_section_align_entry *)
9431 xmalloc (sizeof (struct irix_section_align_entry));
9432 *slot = entry;
9433 entry->name = section;
9434 entry->log = log;
9435 entry->flags = current_section_flags ();
9437 else if (entry->log < log)
9438 entry->log = log;
9441 fprintf (file, "\t.align\t%u\n", log);
9444 /* The IRIX assembler does not record alignment from .align directives,
9445 but takes it from the first .section directive seen. Play file
9446 switching games so that we can emit a .section directive at the
9447 beginning of the file with the proper alignment attached. */
9449 static void
9450 irix_file_start (void)
9452 mips_file_start ();
9454 if (mips_abi == ABI_32)
9455 return;
9457 irix_orig_asm_out_file = asm_out_file;
9458 asm_out_file = tmpfile ();
9460 irix_section_align_htab = htab_create (31, irix_section_align_entry_hash,
9461 irix_section_align_entry_eq, NULL);
9464 static int
9465 irix_section_align_1 (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9467 const struct irix_section_align_entry *entry
9468 = *(const struct irix_section_align_entry **) slot;
9470 irix_asm_named_section_1 (entry->name, entry->flags, 1 << entry->log);
9471 return 1;
9474 static void
9475 copy_file_data (FILE *to, FILE *from)
9477 char buffer[8192];
9478 size_t len;
9479 rewind (from);
9480 if (ferror (from))
9481 fatal_error ("can't rewind temp file: %m");
9483 while ((len = fread (buffer, 1, sizeof (buffer), from)) > 0)
9484 if (fwrite (buffer, 1, len, to) != len)
9485 fatal_error ("can't write to output file: %m");
9487 if (ferror (from))
9488 fatal_error ("can't read from temp file: %m");
9490 if (fclose (from))
9491 fatal_error ("can't close temp file: %m");
9494 static void
9495 irix_file_end (void)
9497 if (mips_abi != ABI_32)
9499 /* Emit section directives with the proper alignment at the top of the
9500 real output file. */
9501 FILE *temp = asm_out_file;
9502 asm_out_file = irix_orig_asm_out_file;
9503 htab_traverse (irix_section_align_htab, irix_section_align_1, NULL);
9505 /* Copy the data emitted to the temp file to the real output file. */
9506 copy_file_data (asm_out_file, temp);
9509 mips_file_end ();
9513 /* Implement TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS. Make sure that .sdata and
9514 .sbss sections get the SECTION_SMALL flag: this isn't set by the
9515 default code. */
9517 static unsigned int
9518 irix_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *section, int relocs_p)
9520 unsigned int flags;
9522 flags = default_section_type_flags (decl, section, relocs_p);
9524 if (strcmp (section, ".sdata") == 0
9525 || strcmp (section, ".sbss") == 0
9526 || strncmp (section, ".gnu.linkonce.s.", 16) == 0
9527 || strncmp (section, ".gnu.linkonce.sb.", 17) == 0)
9528 flags |= SECTION_SMALL;
9530 return flags;
9533 #endif /* TARGET_IRIX */
9535 #include "gt-mips.h"